EP1686929A4 - Stabilized intervertebral disc barrier - Google Patents

Stabilized intervertebral disc barrier

Info

Publication number
EP1686929A4
EP1686929A4 EP04795837A EP04795837A EP1686929A4 EP 1686929 A4 EP1686929 A4 EP 1686929A4 EP 04795837 A EP04795837 A EP 04795837A EP 04795837 A EP04795837 A EP 04795837A EP 1686929 A4 EP1686929 A4 EP 1686929A4
Authority
EP
European Patent Office
Prior art keywords
anulus
augmentation device
barrier
disc
implant
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Withdrawn
Application number
EP04795837A
Other languages
German (de)
French (fr)
Other versions
EP1686929A2 (en
Inventor
Greg Lambrecht
Robert Kevin Moore
Jacob Einhorn
Sean Kavanaugh
Chris Tarapata
Thomas Boyajian
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Intrinsic Therapeutics Inc
Original Assignee
Intrinsic Therapeutics Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Intrinsic Therapeutics Inc filed Critical Intrinsic Therapeutics Inc
Publication of EP1686929A2 publication Critical patent/EP1686929A2/en
Publication of EP1686929A4 publication Critical patent/EP1686929A4/en
Withdrawn legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/44Joints for the spine, e.g. vertebrae, spinal discs
    • A61F2/442Intervertebral or spinal discs, e.g. resilient
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/44Joints for the spine, e.g. vertebrae, spinal discs
    • A61F2/441Joints for the spine, e.g. vertebrae, spinal discs made of inflatable pockets or chambers filled with fluid, e.g. with hydrogel
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/46Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor
    • A61F2/4603Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor for insertion or extraction of endoprosthetic joints or of accessories thereof
    • A61F2/4611Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor for insertion or extraction of endoprosthetic joints or of accessories thereof of spinal prostheses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/46Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor
    • A61F2/4657Measuring instruments used for implanting artificial joints
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/28Bones
    • A61F2/2846Support means for bone substitute or for bone graft implants, e.g. membranes or plates for covering bone defects
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/30721Accessories
    • A61F2/30723Plugs or restrictors for sealing a cement-receiving space
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/30767Special external or bone-contacting surface, e.g. coating for improving bone ingrowth
    • A61F2/30907Nets or sleeves applied to surface of prostheses or in cement
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/46Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor
    • A61F2/4601Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor for introducing bone substitute, for implanting bone graft implants or for compacting them in the bone cavity
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/28Bones
    • A61F2002/2817Bone stimulation by chemical reactions or by osteogenic or biological products for enhancing ossification, e.g. by bone morphogenetic or morphogenic proteins [BMP] or by transforming growth factors [TGF]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30003Material related properties of the prosthesis or of a coating on the prosthesis
    • A61F2002/30004Material related properties of the prosthesis or of a coating on the prosthesis the prosthesis being made from materials having different values of a given property at different locations within the same prosthesis
    • A61F2002/30014Material related properties of the prosthesis or of a coating on the prosthesis the prosthesis being made from materials having different values of a given property at different locations within the same prosthesis differing in elasticity, stiffness or compressibility
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30003Material related properties of the prosthesis or of a coating on the prosthesis
    • A61F2002/3006Properties of materials and coating materials
    • A61F2002/30062(bio)absorbable, biodegradable, bioerodable, (bio)resorbable, resorptive
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30003Material related properties of the prosthesis or of a coating on the prosthesis
    • A61F2002/3006Properties of materials and coating materials
    • A61F2002/30075Properties of materials and coating materials swellable, e.g. when wetted
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30003Material related properties of the prosthesis or of a coating on the prosthesis
    • A61F2002/3006Properties of materials and coating materials
    • A61F2002/30092Properties of materials and coating materials using shape memory or superelastic materials, e.g. nitinol
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/3011Cross-sections or two-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30112Rounded shapes, e.g. with rounded corners
    • A61F2002/30131Rounded shapes, e.g. with rounded corners horseshoe- or crescent- or C-shaped or U-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/3011Cross-sections or two-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30112Rounded shapes, e.g. with rounded corners
    • A61F2002/30136Rounded shapes, e.g. with rounded corners undulated or wavy, e.g. serpentine-shaped or zigzag-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/3011Cross-sections or two-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30159Concave polygonal shapes
    • A61F2002/30166H-shaped or I-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/3011Cross-sections or two-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30159Concave polygonal shapes
    • A61F2002/30172T-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/3011Cross-sections or two-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30159Concave polygonal shapes
    • A61F2002/30177W-shaped, M-shaped or sigma shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/3011Cross-sections or two-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30182Other shapes
    • A61F2002/30187D-shaped or half-disc-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/30199Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/302Three-dimensional shapes toroidal, e.g. rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/30199Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30224Three-dimensional shapes cylindrical
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/30199Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30224Three-dimensional shapes cylindrical
    • A61F2002/30228Cylinders of elliptical or oval basis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/30199Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30261Three-dimensional shapes parallelepipedal
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/30199Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30289Three-dimensional shapes helically-coiled
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30108Shapes
    • A61F2002/30199Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2002/30291Three-dimensional shapes spirally-coiled, i.e. having a 2D spiral cross-section
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30316The prosthesis having different structural features at different locations within the same prosthesis; Connections between prosthetic parts; Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30329Connections or couplings between prosthetic parts, e.g. between modular parts; Connecting elements
    • A61F2002/30462Connections or couplings between prosthetic parts, e.g. between modular parts; Connecting elements retained or tied with a rope, string, thread, wire or cable
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30316The prosthesis having different structural features at different locations within the same prosthesis; Connections between prosthetic parts; Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30535Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30565Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for having spring elements
    • A61F2002/30566Helical springs
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30316The prosthesis having different structural features at different locations within the same prosthesis; Connections between prosthetic parts; Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30535Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30565Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for having spring elements
    • A61F2002/30571Leaf springs
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30316The prosthesis having different structural features at different locations within the same prosthesis; Connections between prosthetic parts; Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30535Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30576Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for with extending fixation tabs
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30316The prosthesis having different structural features at different locations within the same prosthesis; Connections between prosthetic parts; Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30535Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30581Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for having a pocket filled with fluid, e.g. liquid
    • A61F2002/30583Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for having a pocket filled with fluid, e.g. liquid filled with hardenable fluid, e.g. curable in-situ
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30316The prosthesis having different structural features at different locations within the same prosthesis; Connections between prosthetic parts; Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30535Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30589Sealing means
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30316The prosthesis having different structural features at different locations within the same prosthesis; Connections between prosthetic parts; Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30535Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for
    • A61F2002/30601Special structural features of bone or joint prostheses not otherwise provided for telescopic
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2002/30001Additional features of subject-matter classified in A61F2/28, A61F2/30 and subgroups thereof
    • A61F2002/30667Features concerning an interaction with the environment or a particular use of the prosthesis
    • A61F2002/30677Means for introducing or releasing pharmaceutical products, e.g. antibiotics, into the body
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/30767Special external or bone-contacting surface, e.g. coating for improving bone ingrowth
    • A61F2/30771Special external or bone-contacting surface, e.g. coating for improving bone ingrowth applied in original prostheses, e.g. holes or grooves
    • A61F2002/30772Apertures or holes, e.g. of circular cross section
    • A61F2002/30777Oblong apertures
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/30767Special external or bone-contacting surface, e.g. coating for improving bone ingrowth
    • A61F2/30771Special external or bone-contacting surface, e.g. coating for improving bone ingrowth applied in original prostheses, e.g. holes or grooves
    • A61F2002/30772Apertures or holes, e.g. of circular cross section
    • A61F2002/30784Plurality of holes
    • A61F2002/30785Plurality of holes parallel
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/30767Special external or bone-contacting surface, e.g. coating for improving bone ingrowth
    • A61F2/30907Nets or sleeves applied to surface of prostheses or in cement
    • A61F2002/30909Nets
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/3094Designing or manufacturing processes
    • A61F2002/30971Laminates, i.e. layered products
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/44Joints for the spine, e.g. vertebrae, spinal discs
    • A61F2/442Intervertebral or spinal discs, e.g. resilient
    • A61F2002/4435Support means or repair of the natural disc wall, i.e. annulus, e.g. using plates, membranes or meshes
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/44Joints for the spine, e.g. vertebrae, spinal discs
    • A61F2/442Intervertebral or spinal discs, e.g. resilient
    • A61F2002/444Intervertebral or spinal discs, e.g. resilient for replacing the nucleus pulposus
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/44Joints for the spine, e.g. vertebrae, spinal discs
    • A61F2002/448Joints for the spine, e.g. vertebrae, spinal discs comprising multiple adjacent spinal implants within the same intervertebral space or within the same vertebra, e.g. comprising two adjacent spinal implants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/46Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor
    • A61F2002/4635Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor using minimally invasive surgery
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/46Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor
    • A61F2/4657Measuring instruments used for implanting artificial joints
    • A61F2002/4658Measuring instruments used for implanting artificial joints for measuring dimensions, e.g. length
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/46Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor
    • A61F2/4657Measuring instruments used for implanting artificial joints
    • A61F2002/4658Measuring instruments used for implanting artificial joints for measuring dimensions, e.g. length
    • A61F2002/4661Measuring instruments used for implanting artificial joints for measuring dimensions, e.g. length for measuring thickness
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2/00Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
    • A61F2/02Prostheses implantable into the body
    • A61F2/30Joints
    • A61F2/46Special tools or methods for implanting or extracting artificial joints, accessories, bone grafts or substitutes, or particular adaptations therefor
    • A61F2/4657Measuring instruments used for implanting artificial joints
    • A61F2002/4662Measuring instruments used for implanting artificial joints for measuring penetration depth
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2210/00Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2210/0004Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof bioabsorbable
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2210/00Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2210/0014Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof using shape memory or superelastic materials, e.g. nitinol
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2210/00Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2210/0061Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof swellable
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2210/00Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2210/0085Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof hardenable in situ, e.g. epoxy resins
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2220/00Fixations or connections for prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2220/0025Connections or couplings between prosthetic parts, e.g. between modular parts; Connecting elements
    • A61F2220/0075Connections or couplings between prosthetic parts, e.g. between modular parts; Connecting elements sutured, ligatured or stitched, retained or tied with a rope, string, thread, wire or cable
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0002Two-dimensional shapes, e.g. cross-sections
    • A61F2230/0004Rounded shapes, e.g. with rounded corners
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0002Two-dimensional shapes, e.g. cross-sections
    • A61F2230/0004Rounded shapes, e.g. with rounded corners
    • A61F2230/0013Horseshoe-shaped, e.g. crescent-shaped, C-shaped, U-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0002Two-dimensional shapes, e.g. cross-sections
    • A61F2230/0028Shapes in the form of latin or greek characters
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0002Two-dimensional shapes, e.g. cross-sections
    • A61F2230/0028Shapes in the form of latin or greek characters
    • A61F2230/0034D-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0002Two-dimensional shapes, e.g. cross-sections
    • A61F2230/0028Shapes in the form of latin or greek characters
    • A61F2230/0052T-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0002Two-dimensional shapes, e.g. cross-sections
    • A61F2230/0028Shapes in the form of latin or greek characters
    • A61F2230/0056W-shaped, e.g. M-shaped, sigma-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0063Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2230/0065Three-dimensional shapes toroidal, e.g. ring-shaped, doughnut-shaped
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0063Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2230/0069Three-dimensional shapes cylindrical
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0063Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2230/0082Three-dimensional shapes parallelepipedal
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2230/00Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2230/0063Three-dimensional shapes
    • A61F2230/0091Three-dimensional shapes helically-coiled or spirally-coiled, i.e. having a 2-D spiral cross-section
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2250/00Special features of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
    • A61F2250/0014Special features of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof having different values of a given property or geometrical feature, e.g. mechanical property or material property, at different locations within the same prosthesis
    • A61F2250/0018Special features of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof having different values of a given property or geometrical feature, e.g. mechanical property or material property, at different locations within the same prosthesis differing in elasticity, stiffness or compressibility
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2310/00Prostheses classified in A61F2/28 or A61F2/30 - A61F2/44 being constructed from or coated with a particular material
    • A61F2310/00005The prosthesis being constructed from a particular material
    • A61F2310/00011Metals or alloys
    • A61F2310/00017Iron- or Fe-based alloys, e.g. stainless steel
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2310/00Prostheses classified in A61F2/28 or A61F2/30 - A61F2/44 being constructed from or coated with a particular material
    • A61F2310/00005The prosthesis being constructed from a particular material
    • A61F2310/00011Metals or alloys
    • A61F2310/00023Titanium or titanium-based alloys, e.g. Ti-Ni alloys
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2310/00Prostheses classified in A61F2/28 or A61F2/30 - A61F2/44 being constructed from or coated with a particular material
    • A61F2310/00005The prosthesis being constructed from a particular material
    • A61F2310/00011Metals or alloys
    • A61F2310/00029Cobalt-based alloys, e.g. Co-Cr alloys or Vitallium
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2310/00Prostheses classified in A61F2/28 or A61F2/30 - A61F2/44 being constructed from or coated with a particular material
    • A61F2310/00005The prosthesis being constructed from a particular material
    • A61F2310/00161Carbon; Graphite
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2310/00Prostheses classified in A61F2/28 or A61F2/30 - A61F2/44 being constructed from or coated with a particular material
    • A61F2310/00005The prosthesis being constructed from a particular material
    • A61F2310/00179Ceramics or ceramic-like structures
    • A61F2310/00293Ceramics or ceramic-like structures containing a phosphorus-containing compound, e.g. apatite
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2310/00Prostheses classified in A61F2/28 or A61F2/30 - A61F2/44 being constructed from or coated with a particular material
    • A61F2310/00005The prosthesis being constructed from a particular material
    • A61F2310/00365Proteins; Polypeptides; Degradation products thereof
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2310/00Prostheses classified in A61F2/28 or A61F2/30 - A61F2/44 being constructed from or coated with a particular material
    • A61F2310/00389The prosthesis being coated or covered with a particular material
    • A61F2310/0097Coating or prosthesis-covering structure made of pharmaceutical products, e.g. antibiotics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61FFILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
    • A61F2310/00Prostheses classified in A61F2/28 or A61F2/30 - A61F2/44 being constructed from or coated with a particular material
    • A61F2310/00389The prosthesis being coated or covered with a particular material
    • A61F2310/00976Coating or prosthesis-covering structure made of proteins or of polypeptides, e.g. of bone morphogenic proteins BMP or of transforming growth factors TGF

Definitions

  • the present invention relates generally to the surgical treatment of intervertebral discs in the lumbar, cervical, or thoracic spine that have suffered from tears in the anulus fibrosis, herniation of the nucleus pulposus and/or significant disc height loss.
  • the disc performs the important role of absorbing mechanical loads while allowing for constrained flexibility of the spine.
  • the disc is composed of a soft, central nucleus pulposus (NP) surrounded by a tough, woven anulus fibrosis (AF). Herniation is a result of a weakening in the AF.
  • NP NP are then removed from within the disc space either through the herniation site or tlirough an incision in the AF. This removal of extra NP is commonly done to minimize the risk of recurrent herniation.
  • the most significant drawbacks of discectomy are recurrence of herniation, recurrence of radicular symptoms, and increasing low back pain. Re-herniation can occur in up to 21% of cases. The site for re-herniation is most commonly the same level and side as the previous herniation and can occur through the same weakened site in the AF.
  • Surgical repair meshes are used throughout the body to treat and repair damaged tissue structures such as intralinguinal hernias, hemiated discs and to close iatrogenic holes and incisions as may occur elsewhere.
  • Certain physiological environments present challenges to precise and minimally invasive delivery.
  • An intervertebral disc provides a dynamic environment that produces high loads and pressures. Typically implants designed for this environment must be capable of enduring such conditions for long periods of time. Also, the difficulty and danger of the implantation procedure itself, due to the proximity of the spinal cord, limits the size and ease of placement of the implant.
  • One or more further embodiments of the invention addresses the need for a durable fatigue resistant repair mesh capable of withstanding the dynamic environment generic to intervertebral discs.
  • anulus augmentation devices including, but not limited to, surgical meshes, barriers, and patches for treatment or augmentation of tissues within pathologic spinal discs.
  • One or more embodiments comprise resilient surgical meshes that may be compressed for minimally invasive delivery and which are robust, stable, and resist fatigue and stress. These meshes are particularly well suited for intervertebral disc applications because they are durable enough to withstand intense cyclical loading and resist expulsion through a defect while not degrading over time.
  • Several embodiments of the present invention seek to exploit the individual characteristics of various anulus and nuclear augmentation devices to optimize the performance of both within the intervertebral disc.
  • one or more of the embodiments of the present invention provide minimally invasive and removable devices for closing a defect in an anulus and augmenting the nucleus. These devices may be permanent, semi-permanent, or removable.
  • One function of anulus augmentation devices is to prevent or minimize the extrusion of materials from within the space normally occupied by the nucleus pulposus and inner anulus fibrosus.
  • One function of nuclear augmentation devices is to at least temporarily add material to restore diminished disc height and pressure.
  • Nuclear augmentation devices can also induce the growth or formation of material within the nuclear space. Accordingly, the inventive combination of these devices can create a synergistic effect wherein the anulus and nuclear augmentation devices serve to restore biomechanical function in a more natural biomimetic way.
  • both devices may be delivered more easily and less invasively.
  • the pressurized environment made possible tlirough the addition of nuclear augmentation material and closing of the anulus serves both to restrain the nuclear augmentation and anchor the anulus augmentation in place.
  • the phrase "anulus augmentation device” shall be given its ordinary meaning and shall also include devices that at least partially cover, close or seal a defect in an intervertebral disc, including, for example, barriers, meshes, patches, membranes, sealing means or closure devices.
  • the anulus augmentation device augments the anulus by sealing a defect in the anulus.
  • one or more barriers, meshes, patches, membranes, sealing means or closure devices comprise a support member or frame.
  • a barrier that comprises a membrane and a frame is provided.
  • augmenting or reinforcing shall be given their ordinary meaning and shall also mean supporting, covering, closing, patching, or sealing.
  • one or more anulus augmentation devices are provided with one or more nuclear augmentation devices, hi some embodiments, the anulus barrier is integral with the nucleus augmentation, hi other embodiments, at least a portion of the barrier is separate from or independent of the nuclear augmentation.
  • One or more of the embodiments of the present invention additionally provide an anulus augmentation device that is adapted for use with flowable nuclear augmentation material such that the flowable material cannot escape from the anulus after the anulus augmentation device has been implanted.
  • a disc augmentation system configured to repair or rehabilitate an intervertebral disc.
  • the system comprises at least one anulus augmentation device, and at least one nuclear augmentation material.
  • the anulus augmentation device prevents or minimizes the extrusion of materials from within the space normally occupied by the nucleus pulposus and inner anulus fibrosus.
  • the anulus augmentation device is configured for minimally invasive implantation and deployment.
  • the anulus augmentation device may either be a permanent implant, or it may removable.
  • the nuclear augmentation material may restore diminished disc height and/or pressure. It may include factors for inducing the growth or formation of material within the nuclear space. It may either be permanent, removable, or absorbable.
  • the nuclear augmentation material may be in the form of liquids, gels, solids, or gases, hi one embodiment, the nuclear augmentation material comprises materials selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: steroids, antibiotics, tissue necrosis factors, tissue necrosis factor antagonists, analgesics, growth factors, genes, gene vectors, hyaluronic acid, noncross-linked collagen, collagen, fibren, liquid fat, oils, synthetic polymers, polyethylene glycol, liquid silicones, synthetic oils, saline and hydrogel.
  • the hydrogel may be selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: acrylonitriles, acrylic acids, polyacrylimides, acrylimides, acrylimidines, polyacrylnitriles, and polyvinyl alcohols.
  • Solid form nuclear augmentation materials may be in the form of geometric shapes such as cubes, spheroids, disc-like components, ellipsoid, rhombohedral, cylindrical, or amorphous.
  • the solid material may be in powder form, and may be selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: titanium, stainless steel, nitinol, cobalt, chrome, resorbable materials, polyurethane, polyesther, PEEK, PET, FEP, PTFE, ePTFE, PMMA, nylon, carbon fiber, Delrin, polyvinyl alcohol gels, polyglycolic acid, polyethylene glycol, silicone gel, silicone rubber, vulcanized rubber, gas-filled vesicles, bone, hydroxy apetite, collagen such as cross-linked collagen, muscle tissue, fat, cellulose, keratin, cartilage, protein polymers, transplanted nucleus pulposus, bioengineered nucleus pulposus, transplanted anulus fibrosis, and bioengineered anulus fibrosis.
  • the nuclear augmentation material may additionally comprise a biologically active compound.
  • the compound may be selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: drug carriers, genetic vectors, genes, therapeutic agents, growth renewal agents, growth inhibitory agents, analgesics, anti-infectious agents, and anti-inflammatory drugs.
  • the anulus augmentation device comprises materials selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: steroids, antibiotics, tissue necrosis factors, tissue necrosis factor antagonists, analgesics, growth factors, genes, gene vectors, hyaluronic acid, noncross-linked collagen, collagen, fibren, liquid fat, oils, synthetic polymers, polyethylene glycol, liquid silicones, synthetic oils, saline, hydrogel (e.g., acrylonitriles, acrylic acids, polyacrylimides, acrylimides, acrylimidines, polyacrylnitriles, and polyvinyl alcohols), and other suitable materials.
  • steroids e.g., acrylonitriles, acrylic acids, polyacrylimides, acrylimides, acrylimidines, polyacrylnitriles, and polyvinyl alcohols
  • the anulus augmentation device is constructed from one or more of the following materials: titanium, stainless steel, nitinol, cobalt, chrome, resorbable materials, polyurethane, polyesther, PEEK, PET, FEP, PTFE, ePTFE, PMMA, nylon, carbon fiber, Delrin, polyvinyl alcohol gels, polyglycohc acid, polyethylene glycol, silicone gel, silicone rubber, vulcanized rubber, gas-filled vesicles, bone, hydroxy apetite, collagen such as cross-linked collagen, muscle tissue, fat, cellulose, keratin, cartilage, and protein polymers.
  • the anulus augmentation device may comprise a biologically active compound.
  • the compound may be selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: drug carriers, genetic vectors, genes, therapeutic agents, growth renewal agents, growth inhibitory agents, analgesics, anti-infectious agents, and anti-inflammatory drags, hi some embodiments, the biologically active compound is coupled to the barrier, sealing device, closing device or membrane, hi some embodiments, the biologically active compound coats the barrier, sealing device, closing device or membrane.
  • an anulus augmentation device for reinforcing an intervertebral disc
  • the anulus augmentation device comprises a mesh frame, wherein the mesh frame comprises a plurality of flexible curvilinear members.
  • the curvalinear elements are interconnected.
  • the interconnected curvilinear members are adapted to provide flexibility and resilience to the mesh frame.
  • the curvilinear members form a horizontal member or central strut.
  • the curvilinear members are arranged in a parallel configuration.
  • the curvilinear members comprise a metal alloy such as steel, nickel titanium, cobalt chrome, or combinations thereof.
  • the curvilinear members are constructed of nylon, polyvinyl alcohol, polyethylene, polyurethane, polypropylene, polycaprolactone, polyacrylate, ethylene-vinyl acetate, polystyrene, polyvinyl oxide, polyvinyl fluoride, polyvinyl imidazoles, chlorosulphonated polyolefm, polyethylene oxide, polytetrafluoroethylene, acetal, poly(p-phenyleneterephtalamide) (KevlarTM), poly carbonate, carbon, graphite, or a combination thereof.
  • a membrane encapsulates, covers or coats at least a portion of the mesh frame, hi some embodiments, the membrane is coupled to the frame.
  • the membrane of some embodiments is constructed of polymers, elastomers, gels, elastin, albumin, collagen, fibrin, keratin, or a combination thereof, hi several embodiments, the membrane comprises antibodies, antiseptics, genetic vectors, bone morphogenic proteins, steroids, cortisones, growth factors, or a combination thereof.
  • the membrane may be a coating material.
  • the mesh frame is concave along at least a portion of at least one axis of said mesh frame.
  • the mesh frame has a length in the range of about 0.5 cm to about 5 cm.
  • the mesh frame is sized to cover at least a portion of an interior surface of an anulus lamella
  • the mesh frame is adapted to extend circumferentially along the entire surface of an anulus lamella.
  • an anulus augmentation device comprising at least one projection that radiates from a mesh frame is provided.
  • the mesh frame has a vertical cross-section that is flat, concave, convex, or curvilinear. The horizontal cross-section can be concave, convex, flat, or kidney bean shaped.
  • an anulus augmentation device for reinforcing an intervertebral disc comprises a mesh frame having a horizontal axis and a vertical axis, hi one embodiment, the mesh fame is concave along at least a portion the horizontal axis or the vertical axis, hi one embodiment, one or more projections radiate from the horizontal axis or the vertical axis of the mesh frame.
  • the projections are adapted to stabilize the anulus augmentation device, hi one embodiment, a stabilizing projection has at least one dimension that is larger than the mesh frame, h other embodiments, the projection is smaller than the mesh frame.
  • an intervertebral disc implant comprising a posterior support member having a first terminus and a second terminus.
  • an anterior projection extends outwardly from the posterior support member. The anterior projection is attached to at least the first terminus or the second temiinus of the posterior support member.
  • an intervertebral disc implant comprising a posterior support member having a first temiinus and a second terminus and an anterior projection having a first end and a second end is provided. The anterior projection extends outwardly from the posterior support member.
  • the first end of the * anterior projection is coupled to the first terminus of the posterior support member; and the second end of the anterior projection is coupled to the second terminus of the posterior support member, thereby substantially forming a bow-shaped implant.
  • the posterior support member and the anterior projection can be constructed of any suitable material, including but not limited to the materials described above for the mesh frame and the membrane.
  • a fatigue-resistant surgical mesh comprising rails is provided, hi one embodiment, the mesh comprises a top rail, a bottom rail coupled to the top rail, wherein the top rail and said bottom rail are coupled to each other at a first end and second end.
  • the top rail and the bottom rail extend to form a gap that is defined between the rails along at least a portion of the distance between the ends.
  • a spinal implant for treatment of an intervertebral disc is provided, hi one embodiment, a barrier or patch with a volume corresponding to the amount of material removed during a discectomy procedure is implanted, h one embodiment, the implant has a volume in a range of about 0.2 to about 2.0 cc.
  • an intervertebral disc implant comprising a barrier forming a contiguous band is provided.
  • the band has variable heights or widths, hi one embodiment, the band has different degrees of flexibility along at least one axis.
  • a method of repairing or rehabilitating an intervertebral disc comprises inserting at least one anulus augmentation device into the disc, and inserting at least one nuclear augmentation material, to be held within the disc by the anulus augmentation device.
  • the nuclear augmentation material may confomi to a first, healthy region of the anulus, while the anulus augmentation device conforms to a second, weaker region of the anulus.
  • a method of repairing defective regions within a spinal disc comprises providing a surgical mesh, implanting the surgical mesh along an anulus surface, and positioning the surgical mesh at least such that about 2 mm of the device spans beyond at least one edge of the defective region of the disc.
  • Figure 1 A shows a transverse section of a portion of a functional spine unit, in which part of a vertebra and intervertebral disc are depicted.
  • Figure IB shows a sagittal cross section of a portion of a functional spine unit shown in Figure IA, in which two lumbar vertebrae and the intervertebral disc are visible.
  • Figure IC shows partial disruption of the inner layers of an anulus fibrosis.
  • Figure 2A shows a transverse section of one aspect of the present invention prior to supporting a hemiated segment, as shown in one embodiment.
  • Figure 2B shows a transverse section of the construct in Fig. 2A supporting the hemiated segment.
  • Figure 3A shows a transverse section of another embodiment of the disclosed invention after placement of the device.
  • Figure 3B shows a transverse section of the construct in Fig. 3A after tension is applied to support the hemiated segment.
  • Figure 4A shows a transverse view of an alternate embodiment of the invention.
  • Figure 4B shows a sagittal view of the alternate embodiment shown in Figure 4A.
  • Figure 5A shows a transverse view of another aspect of the present invention, as shown in one embodiment.
  • Figure 5B shows the delivery tube of Figure 5 A being used to displace the hemiated segment to within its pre-herniated borders.
  • Figure 5C shows a one-piece embodiment of the invention in an anchored and supporting position.
  • Figure 6 shows one embodiment of the invention supporting a weakened posterior anulus fibrosis.
  • Figure 7A shows a transverse section of another aspect of the disclosed invention demonstrating two stages involved in augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc.
  • Figure 7B shows a sagittal view of the invention shown in Figure 7A.
  • Figure 8 shows a transverse section of one aspect of the disclosed invention involving augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc and support/closure of the anulus fibrosis.
  • Figure 9A shows a transverse section of one aspect of the invention involving augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc with the flexible augmentation material anchored to the anterior lateral anulus fibrosis.
  • Figure 9B shows a transverse section of one aspect of the disclosed invention involving augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc with the flexible augmentation material anchored to the anulus fibrosis by a one-piece anchor.
  • Figure 10A shows a transverse section of one aspect of the disclosed invention involving augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc.
  • Figure 10B shows the construct of Figure 10A after the augmentation material has been inserted into the disc.
  • Figure 11 illustrates a transverse section of a barrier mounted within an anulus.
  • Figure 12 shows a sagittal view of the barrier of Figure 11.
  • Figure 13 shows a transverse section of a barrier anchored within a disc.
  • Figure 14 illustrates a sagittal view of the barrier shown in Figure 13.
  • Figure 15 illustrates the use of a second anchoring device for a barrier mounted within a disc.
  • Figure 16A is an transverse view of the intervertebral disc.
  • Figure 16B is a sagittal section along the midline of the intervertebral disc.
  • Figure 17 is an axial view of the intervertebral disc with the right half of a sealing means of a barrier means being placed against the interior aspect of a defect in anulus fibrosis by a dissection/delivery tool.
  • Figure 18 illustrates a full sealing means placed on the interior aspect of a defect in anulus fibrosis.
  • Figure 19 depicts the sealing means of Figure 18 being secured to tissues surrounding the defect.
  • Figure 20 depicts the sealing means of Figure 19 after fixation means have been passed into surrounding tissues.
  • Figure 21 A depicts an axial view of the sealing means of Figure 20 having enlarging means inserted into the interior cavity.
  • Figure 21B depicts the construct of Figure 21 in a sagittal section.
  • Figure 22A shows an alternative fixation scheme for the sealing means and enlarging means.
  • Figure 22B shows the construct of Figure 22A in a sagittal section with an anchor securing a fixation region of the enlarging means to a superior vertebral body in a location proximate to the defect.
  • Figure 23 A depicts an embodiment of the barrier means of the present invention being secured to an anulus using fixation means, as shown in one embodiment.
  • Figure 23B depicts an embodiment of the barrier means of Figure 23A secured to an anulus by two fixation darts wherein the fixation tool has been removed.
  • Figures 24A and 24B depict a barrier means positioned between layers of the anulus fibrosis on either side of a defect.
  • Figure 25 depicts an axial cross section of a large version of a barrier means.
  • Figure 26 depicts an axial cross section of a barrier means in position across a defect following insertion of two augmentation devices.
  • Figure 27 depicts the barrier means as part of an elongated augmentation device.
  • Figure 28A depicts an axial section of an alternate configuration of the augmentation device of Figure 27.
  • Figure 28B depicts a sagittal section of an alternate configuration of the augmentation device of Figure 27.
  • Figures 29A-D depict deployment of a barrier from an entry site remote from the defect in the anulus fibrosis.
  • Figures 30A, 30B, 31 A, 3 IB, 32A, 32B, 33 A, and 33B depict axial and sectional views, respectively, of various embodiments of the barrier.
  • Figure 34 shows a non-axisymmetric expansion means or frame.
  • Figures 34B and 34C illustrate perspective views of a frame mounted within an intervertebral disc.
  • Figures 35 and 36 illustrate alternate embodiments of the expansion means shown in Figure 34.
  • Figures 37A-C illustrate a front, side, and perspective view, respectively, of an alternate embodiment of the expansion means shown in Figure 34.
  • Figure 38 shows an alternate expansion means to that shown in Figure 37A.
  • Figures 39A-D illustrate a tubular expansion means having a circular cross-section.
  • Figures 40A-I illustrate tubular expansion means.
  • Figures 40A-D illustrate a tubular expansion means having an oval shaped cross-section.
  • Figures 40E, 40F and 401 illustrate a front, back and top view, respectively of the tubular expansion means of Figure 40A having a sealing means covering an exterior surface of an anulus face.
  • Figures 40G and 40H show the tubular expansion means of Figure 40A having a sealing means covering an interior surface of an anulus face.
  • Figures 41A-D illustrate a tubular expansion means having an egg- shaped cross-section.
  • Figure 42A-D depicts cross sections of a preferred embodiment of sealing and enlarging means.
  • Figure 43A and 43B depict an alternative configuration of enlarging means.
  • Figure 44A and 44B depict an alternative shape of the barrier means.
  • Figure 45 is a section of a device used to affix sealing means to tissues surrounding a defect.
  • Figure 46 depicts the use of a thermal device to heat and adhere sealing means to tissues surrounding a defect.
  • Figure 47 depicts an expandable thermal element that can be used to adhere sealing means to tissues surrounding a defect.
  • Figure 48 depicts an alternative embodiment to the thermal device of Figure 46.
  • Figures 49A-G illustrate a method of implanting an intradiscal implant.
  • Figures 50A-F show an alternate method of implanting an intradiscal implant.
  • Figures 51A-C show another alternate method of implanting an intradiscal implant.
  • Figures 52 A and 52B illustrate an implant guide used with the intradiscal implant system.
  • Figure 53A illustrates a barrier having stiffening plate elements.
  • Figure 53B illustrates a sectional view of the barrier of Figure 53A.
  • Figure 54A shows a stiffening plate.
  • Figure 54B shows a sectional view of the stiffemng plate of Figure 54A.
  • Figure 55A illustrates a barrier having stiffening rod elements.
  • Figure 55B illustrates a sectional view of the barrier of Figure 55A.
  • Figure 56A illustrates a stiffening rod.
  • Figure 56B illustrates a sectional view of the stiffening rod of Figure 56A.
  • Figure 57 shows an alternate configuration for the location of the fixation devices of the barrier of Figure 44A.
  • Figures 58A and 58B illustrate a dissection device for an intervertebral disc.
  • Figures 59A and 59B illustrate an alternate dissection device for an intervertebral disc.
  • Figures 60A-C illustrate a dissector component.
  • Figures 61A-D illustrate a method of inserting a disc implant within an intervertebral disc.
  • Figure 62 depicts a cross-sectional transverse view of a barrier device implanted within a disc along the inner surface of a lamella. Implanted conformable nuclear augmentation is also shown in contact with the barrier.
  • Figure 63 shows a cross-sectional transverse view of a barrier device implanted within a disc along an imier surface of a lamella. Implanted nuclear augmentation comprised of a hydrophilic flexible solid is also shown.
  • Figure 64 shows a cross-sectional transverse view of a barrier device implanted within a disc along an inner surface of a lamella.
  • Figure 65 illustrates a sagittal cross-sectional view of a barrier device connected to an inflatable nuclear augmentation device.
  • Figure 66 depicts a sagittal cross-sectional view of a functional spine unit containing a barrier device unit connected to a wedge shaped nuclear augmentation device.
  • Figure 67 shows an anulus augmentation device (such as a mesh) mesh having a series of curvilinear elements.
  • Figures 68A-G show various profiles and cross-sectional views of an anulus augmentation device (such as a mesh), e.g., "U” shaped, “C” shaped, curvilinear shaped, and “D” shaped to extend along and cover the entire inner anulus surface, or portions thereof.
  • Figure 69 shows one embodiment of a mesh with curvilinear elements implanted in an intervertebral disc.
  • Figure 70 shows a wire-type anulus augmentation device.
  • Figures 71 A-E show a frame (e.g., mesh) that has been encapsulated by a membrane or cover to produce an encapsulated mesh.
  • Figures 72A-B show a mesh having a double- wishbone frame.
  • Figures 73A-C shows embodiments of the end or natural hinge portion of the frame, including a looped terminus.
  • Figures 74A-C show some embodiments of the central band or strut.
  • Figures 75A-L show an implant an annulus augmentation device such as a mesh having one or more projections extending into the disc or into a defect.
  • Figure 76 shows an implant comprising a bow-like anterior projection that extends outwardly from a posterior support member.
  • Figures 77A-H show various cross-sectional side views along a horizontal axis of an implant comprising a bow, band or projection.
  • Figures 78A-J show various cross-sectional top views of implants along a vertical axis.
  • Figures 79A-F show a frontal view of a portion of several embodiments of an implant projection.
  • Figures 80A-D show various cross-sections of an implant projection.
  • Figures 81 A-D show looped or bent bow-type projections. Detailed Description of the Preferred Embodiment [0134]
  • Several embodiments of the present invention provide for an in vivo augmented functional spine unit.
  • a functional spine unit includes the bony structures of two adjacent vertebrae (or vertebral bodies), the soft tissue (anulus fibrosis (AF), and optionally nucleus pulposus (NP)) of the intervertebral disc, and the ligaments, musculature and connective tissue comiected to the vertebrae.
  • the intervertebral disc is substantially situated in the intervertebral space formed between the adjacent vertebrae. Augmentation of the functional spine unit can include repair of a hemiated disc segment, support of a weakened, tom or damaged anulus fibrosis, or the addition of material to or replacement of all or part of the nucleus pulposus.
  • FIGS 1 A and IB show the general anatomy of a functional spine unit 45. h this description and the following claims, the terms 'anterior' and 'posterior', 'superior' and 'inferior' are defined by their standard usage in anatomy, i.e., anterior is a direction toward the front (ventral) side of the body or organ, posterior is a direction toward the back (dorsal) side of the body or organ; superior is upward (toward the head) and inferior is lower (toward the feet).
  • Figure IA is an axial view along the transverse axis M of a vertebral body with the intervertebral disc 15 superior to the vertebral body.
  • Axis M shows the anterior (A) and posterior (P) orientation of the functional spine unit within the anatomy.
  • the intervertebral disc 15 contains the anulus fibrosis (AF) 10 which surrounds a central nucleus pulposus (NP) 20.
  • AF anulus fibrosis
  • NP central nucleus pulposus
  • a Hemiated segment 30 is depicted by a dashed-line. The hemiated segment 30 protrudes beyond the pre-hemiated posterior border 40 of the disc.
  • Also shown in this figure are the left 70 and right 70' transverse spinous processes and the posterior spinous process 80.
  • Figure IB is a sagittal section along sagittal axis N through the midline of two adjacent vertebral bodies 50 (superior) and 50' (inferior).
  • Intervertebral disc space 55 is formed between the two vertebral bodies and contains intervertebral disc 15, which supports and cushions the vertebral bodies and permits movement of the two vertebral bodies with respect to each other and other adjacent functional spine units.
  • Intervertebral disc 15 is comprised of the outer AF 10 which normally surrounds and constrains the NP 20 to be wholly within the borders of the intervertebral disc space, hi Figs.
  • IA and IB hemiated segment 30, represented by the dashed-line, has migrated posterior to the pre-hemiated border 40 of the posterior AF of the disc.
  • Axis M extends between the anterior (A) and posterior (P) of the functional spine unit.
  • the vertebral bodies also include facet joints 60 and the superior 90 and inferior 90' pedicle that form the neural foramen 100.
  • Disc height loss occurs when the superior vertebral body 50 moves inferiorly relative to the inferior vertebral body 50'.
  • Partial disruption 121 of the inner layers of the anulus 10 without a true perforation has also been linked to chronic low back pain. Such a disruption 4 is illustrated in Figure IC.
  • the disc herniation constraining devices 13 provide support for returning all or part of the hemiated segment 30 to a position substantially within its pre-hemiated borders 40.
  • the disc herniation constraining device includes an anchor which is positioned at a site within the functional spine unit, such as the superior or inferior vertebral body, or the anterior medial, or anterior lateral anulus fibrosis.
  • the anchor is used as a point against which all or part of the hemiated segment is tensioned so as to return the hemiated segment to its pre-hemiated borders, and thereby relieve pressure on otherwise compressed neural tissue and stmctures.
  • a support member is positioned in or posterior to the hemiated segment, and is connected to the anchor by a connecting member. Sufficient tension is applied to the connecting member so that the support member returns the hemiated segment to a pre-hemiated position.
  • augmentation material is secured within the intervertebral disc space, which assists the NP in cushioning and supporting the inferior and superior vertebral bodies.
  • FIGS. 2A and 2B depict one embodiment of device 13.
  • Figure 2A shows the elements of the constraining device in position to correct the hemiated segment.
  • Anchor 1 is securely established in a location within the functional spine unit, such as the anterior AF shown in the figure.
  • Support member 2 is positioned in or posterior to hemiated segment 30.
  • connection member 3 which serves to connect anchor 1 to support member 2.
  • connection member 2 may traverse tlirough all or part of the hemiated segment.
  • Figure 2B shows the positions of the various elements of the hemiation constraining device 13 when the device 13 is supporting the hemiated segment. Tightening connection member 2 allows it to transmit tensile forces along its length, which causes hemiated segment 30 to move anteriorly, i.e., in the direction of its pre-hemiated borders. Once hemiated segment 30 is in the desired position, connection member 3 is secured in a permanent fashion between anchor 1 and support member 2. This maintains tension between anchor 1 and support member 2 and restricts motion of the hennated segment to within the pre-hemiated borders 40 of the disc.
  • Anchor 1 is depicted in a representative form, as it can take one of many suitable shapes, be made from one of a variety of biocompatible materials, and be constructed so as to fall within a range of stiffness. It can be a permanent device constructed of durable plastic or metal or can be made from a resorbable material such as polylactic acid (PLA) or polyglycohc acid (PGA). Specific embodiments are not shown, but many possible designs would be obvious to anyone skilled in the art.
  • PLA polylactic acid
  • PGA polyglycohc acid
  • Embodiments include, but are not limited to, a barbed anchor made of PLA or a metal coil that can be screwed into the anterior AF.
  • Anchor 1 can be securely established within a portion of the functional spine unit in the usual and customary manner for such devices and locations, such as being screwed into bone, sutured into tissue or bone, or affixed to tissue or bone using an adhesive method, such as cement, or other suitable surgical adhesives. Once established within the bone or tissue, anchor 1 should remain relatively stationary within the bone or tissue.
  • Support member 2 is also depicted in a representative format and shares the same flexibility in material and design as anchor 1. Both device elements can be of the same design, or they can be of different designs, each better suited to being established in healthy and diseased tissue respectively.
  • support member 2 can be a cap or a bead shape, which also serves to secure a tear or puncture in the AF, or it can be bar or plate shaped, with or without barbs to maintain secure contact with the hemiated segment.
  • Support member 2 can be established securely to, within, or posterior to the hemiated segment.
  • the anchor and support member can include suture, bone anchors, soft tissue anchors, tissue adhesives, and materials that support tissue ingrowth although other forms and materials are possible. They may be permanent devices or resorbable. Their attachment to a portion of FSU and hemiated segment must be strong enough to resist the tensional forces that result from repair of the hernia and the loads generated during daily activities.
  • Connection member 3 is also depicted in representative fashion.
  • Member 3 may be in the format of a flexible filament, such as a single or multi-strand suture, wire, or perhaps a rigid rod or broad band of material, for example.
  • the connection member can further include suture, wire, pins, and woven tubes or webs of material. It can be constructed from a variety of materials, either permanent or resorbable, and can be of any shape suitable to fit within the confines of the intervertebral disc space.
  • the material chosen is preferably adapted to be relatively stiff while in tension, and relatively flexible against all other loads. This allows for maximal mobility of the hemiated segment relative to the anchor without the risk of the supported segment moving outside of the pre-hemiated borders of the disc.
  • the comiection member may be an integral component of either the anchor or support member or a separate component.
  • the comiection member and support member could be a length of non-resorbing suture that is coupled to an anchor, tensioned against the anchor, and sewn to the hemiated segment.
  • Figures 3 A and 3B depict another embodiment of device 13.
  • Anchor 1 is positioned in the AF and connection member 3 is attached to anchor 1.
  • Support member 4 is positioned posterior to the posterior-most aspect of hemiated segment 30.
  • Support member 4 does not need to be secured in hemiated segment 30 to cause hemiated segment 30 to move within the pre-hemiated borders 40 of the disc.
  • Support member 4 has the same flexibility in design and material as anchor 1, and may further take the form of a flexible patch or rigid plate or bar of material that is either affixed to the posterior aspect of hemiated segment 30 or is simply in a form that is larger than any hole in the AF directly anterior to support member 4.
  • Figure 3B shows the positions of the elements of the device when tension is applied between anchor 1 and support member 4 along connection member 3. The hemiated segment is displaced anteriorly, within the pre-herniated borders 40 of the disc.
  • Figures 4A and 4B show five examples of suitable anchoring sites within the FSU for anchor 1.
  • Figure 4A shows an axial view of anchor 1 in various positions within the anterior and lateral AF.
  • Figure 4B similarly shows a sagittal view of the various acceptable anchoring sites for anchor 1.
  • Anchor 1 is secured in the superior vertebral body 50, inferior vertebral body 50' or anterior AF 10, although any site that can withstand the tension between anchor 1 and support member 2 along coimection member 3 to support a hemiated segment within its pre-hemiated borders 40 is acceptable.
  • a suitable position for affixing one or more anchors is a location anterior to the hemiated segment such that, when tension is applied along comiection member 3, hemiated segment 30 is returned to a site within the pre-hemiated borders 40.
  • the site chosen for the anchor should be able to withstand the tensile forces applied to the anchor when the comiection member is brought under tension. Because most symptomatic herniations occur in the posterior or posterior lateral directions, the preferable site for anchor placement is anterior to the site of the hemiation. Any portion of the involved FSU is generally acceptable, however the anterior, anterior medial, or anterior lateral AF is preferable.
  • anchor 1 can be a single anchor in any of the shown locations, or there can be multiple anchors 1 affixed in various locations and connected to a support member 2 to support the hemiated segment.
  • Connection member 3 can be one continuous length that is threaded tlirough the sited anchors and the support member, or it can be several individual strands of material each terminated under tension between one or more anchors and one or more support members.
  • the anchor(s) and comiection member(s) may be introduced and implanted in the patient, with the connection member under tension.
  • FIGS 5A-C show an alternate embodiment of hemiation constraining device 13 A.
  • device 13 A a substantially one-piece construct, is delivered through a delivery tube 6, although device 13A could be delivered in a variety of ways including, but not limited to, by hand or by a hand held grasping instrument, hi Figure 5A, device 13A in delivery tube 6 is positioned against hemiated segment 30.
  • the hemiated segment is displaced within its pre-hemiated borders 40 by device 13 A and/or delivery tube 6 such that when, in Figure 5C, device 13A has been delivered through delivery tube 6, and secured within a portion of the FSU, the device supports the displaced hemiated segment within its pre-hemiated border 40.
  • Herniation constraining device 13 A can be made of a variety of materials and have one of many possible forms so long as it allows support of the hemiated segment 30 within the pre-hemiated borders 40 of the disc.
  • Device 13 A can anchor the hemiated segment 30 to any suitable anchoring site within the FSU, including, but not limited to the superior vertebral body, inferior vertebral body, or anterior AF.
  • Device 13 A may be used additionally to close a defect in the AF of hemiated segment 30. Alternatively, any such defect may be left open or may be closed using another means.
  • Figures 6 depicts the substantially one-piece device 13A supporting a weakened segment 30' of the posterior AF 10'. Device 13A is positioned in or posterior to the weakened segment 30' and secured to a portion of the FSU, such as the superior vertebral body 50, shown in the figure, or the inferior vertebral body 50' or anterior or anterior-lateral anulus fibrosis 10. hi certain patients, there may be no obvious hemiation found at surgery.
  • a further embodiment of the present invention involves augmentation of the soft tissues of the intervertebral disc to avoid or reverse disc height loss.
  • Figures 7A and 7B show one embodiment of device 13 securing augmentation material in the intervertebral disc space 55. In the left side of Figure 7 A, anchors 1 have been established in the anterior AF 10.
  • Augmentation material 7 is in the process of being inserted into the .disc space along comiection member 3 which, in this embodiment, has passageway 9. Support member 2' is shown ready to be attached to connection member 3 once the augmentation material 7 is properly situated, hi this embodiment, connection member 3 passes through an aperture 11 in support member 2', although many other methods of affixing support member 2' to connection member 3 are possible and within the scope of this invention.
  • Augmentation material 7 may have a passageway 9, such as a channel, slit or the like, which allows it to slide along the connection member 3, or augmentation material 7 may be solid, and connection member 3 can be tlireaded through augmentation material by means such as needle or other puncturing device.
  • Connection member 3 is affixed at one end to anchor 1 and terminated at its other end by a support member 2', one embodiment of which is shown in the figure in a cap-like configuration.
  • Support member 2' can be affixed to coimection member 3 in a variety of ways, including, but not limited to, swaging support member 2' to comiection member 3.
  • support member 2' is in a cap configuration and has a dimension (diameter or length and width) larger than the optional passageway 9, which serves to prevent augmentation material 7 from displacing posteriorly with respect to anchor 1.
  • FIG. 7 A shows an embodiment in which support member 2' is affixed to comiection member 3 and serves only to prevent augmentation material 7 from moving off comiection member 3.
  • the augmentation device is free to move within the disc space.
  • Figure 7B shows an alternate embodiment in which support member 2' is embedded in a site in the functional spine unit, such as a hemiated segment or posterior anulus fibrosis, to further restrict the movement of augmentation material 7 or spacer material within the disc space.
  • Augmentation or spacer material can be made of any biocompatible, preferably flexible, material.
  • a flexible material is preferably fibrous, like cellulose or bovine or autologous collagen.
  • the augmentation material can be plug or disc shaped. It can further be cube-like, ellipsoid, spheroid or any other suitable shape.
  • the augmentation material can be secured within the intervertebral space by a variety of methods, such as but not limited to, a suture loop attached to, around, or through the material, which is then passed to the anchor and support member.
  • Figures 8, 9 A, 9B and 10A and 10B depict further embodiments of the disc hemiation constraining device 13B in use for augmenting soft tissue, particularly tissue within the intervertebral space, hi the embodiments shown in Figures 8 and 9A, device 13B is secured within the intervertebral disc space providing additional support for NP 20.
  • Anchor 1 is securely affixed in a portion of the FSU, (anterior AF 10 in these figures).
  • Comiection member 3 terminates at support member 2, preventing augmentation material 7 from migrating generally posteriorly with respect to anchor 1.
  • Support member 2 is depicted in these figures as established in various locations, such as the posterior AF 10' in Figure 8, but support member 2 may be anchored in any suitable location within the FSU, as described previously. Support member 2 may be used to close a defect in the posterior AF. It may also be used to displace a hemiated segment to within the pre-herniated borders of the disc by applying tension between anchoring means 1 and 2 along comiection member 3.
  • Figure 9A depicts anchor 1, connection member 3, spacer material 7 and support member 2' (shown in the "cap"-type configuration) inserted as a single construct and anchored to a site within the disc space, such as the inferior or superior vertebral bodies.
  • Coimection member 3 is preferably relatively stiff in tension, but flexible against all other loads.
  • Support member 2' is depicted as a bar element that is larger than passageway 9 in at least one plane.
  • Figure 9B depicts a variation on the embodiment depicted in Figure 9 A.
  • Figure 9B shows substantially one-piece disc augmentation device 13C, secured in the intervertebral disc space.
  • Device 13C has anchor 1, coimection member 3 and augmentation material 7. Augmentation material 7 and anchor 1 could be pre-assembled prior to insertion into the disc space 55 as a single construct.
  • FIGs 10A and 10B show yet another embodiment of the disclosed invention, 13D.
  • two connection members 3 and 3' are attached to anchor 1.
  • Two ' plugs of augmentation material 7 and 7 are inserted into the disc space along connection members 3 and 3'.
  • Connection members 3 and 3' are then bound together (e.g., knotted together, fused, or the like). This forms loop 3" that serves to prevent augmentation materials 7 and 7' from displacing posteriorly.
  • Figure 10B shows the position of the augmentation material 7 after it is secured by the loop 3" and anchor 1.
  • augmentation material can be used in this embodiment, such as using a single plug of augmentation material, or two comiection members leading from anchor 1 with each of the connection members being bound to at least one other comiection member. It could further be accomplished with more than one anchor with at least one comiection member leading from each anchor, and each of the connection members being bound to at least one other comiection member.
  • Any of the devices described herein can be used for closing defects in the AF whether created surgically or during the herniation event. Such methods may also involve the addition of biocompatible material to either the AF or NP. This material could include sequestered or extruded segments of the NP found outside the pre-hemiated borders of the disc.
  • Figures 11-15 illustrate devices used in and methods for closing a defect in an anulus fibrosis.
  • One method involves the insertion of a barrier or barrier means 12 into the disc 15. This procedure can accompany surgical discectomy. It can also be done without the removal of any portion of the disc 15 and further in combination with the insertion of an augmentation material or device into the disc 15.
  • the method consists of inserting the barrier 12 into the interior of the disc 15 and positioning it proximate to the interior aspect of the anulus defect 16.
  • the barrier material is preferably considerably larger in area than the size of the defect 16, such that at least some portion of the barrier means 12 abuts healthier anulus fibrosis 10.
  • the device acts to seal the anulus defect 16, recreating the closed isobaric environment of a healthy disc nucleus 20.
  • This closure can be achieved simply by an over-sizing of the implant relative to the defect 16.
  • the barrier 12 is affixed to the anulus surrounding the anulus defect 16. This can be achieved with sutures, staples, glues or other suitable fixation means or fixation device 14.
  • the barrier means 12 can also be larger in area than the defect 16 and be affixed to a tissue or structure opposite the defect 16, e.g., anterior tissue in the case of a posterior defect.
  • the barrier means 12 is preferably flexible in nature.
  • the barrier means 12 can be constracted of a woven material such as DacronTM or NylonTM, a synthetic polyamide or polyester, a polyethylene, and can further be an expanded material, such as expanded polytetrafluroethylene (e-PTFE), for example.
  • the barrier means 12 can also be a biologic material such as cross-linked collagen or cellulous.
  • the barrier means 12 can be a single piece of material. It can have an expandable means or component that allows it to be expanded from a compressed state after insertion into the interior of the disc 15. This expandable means can be active, such as a balloon, or passive, such as a hydrophilic material.
  • the expandable means can also be a self-expanding elastically deforming material, for example.
  • Figures 11 and 12 illustrate a barrier 12 mounted within an anulus 10 and covering an anulus defect 16.
  • the barrier 12 can be secured to the anulus 10 with a fixation mechanism or fixation means 14.
  • the fixation means 14 can include a plurality of suture loops placed tlirough the barrier 12 and the anulus 10. Such fixation can prevent motion or slipping of the barrier 12 away from the anulus defect 16.
  • the barrier means 12 can also be anchored to the disc 15 in multiple locations, hi one preferred embodiment, shown in Figures 13 and 14, the barrier means 12 can be affixed to the anulus tissue 10 in or surrounding the defect and further affixed to a secondary fixation site opposite the defect, e.g.
  • fixation means 14 can be used to attach the barrier 12 to the anulus 10 near the defect 16, while an anchoring mechanism 18 can secure the barrier 12 to a secondary fixation site.
  • a connector 22 can attach the barrier 12 to the anchor 18.
  • Tension can be applied between the primary and secondary fixation sites tlirough a connector 22 so as to move the anulus defect 16 toward the secondary fixation site. This may be particularly beneficial in closing defects 16 that result in posterior herniations.
  • the hemiation can be moved and supported away from any posterior neural stmctures while further closing any defect in the anulus 10.
  • the barrier means 12 can further be integral to a fixation means such that the barrier means affixes itself to tissues within the functional spinal unit.
  • Any of the methods described above can be augmented by the use of a second barrier or a second barrier means 24 placed proximate to the outer aspect of the defect 16 as shown in Figure 15.
  • the second barrier 24 can further be affixed to the inner barrier means 12 by the use of a fixation means 14 such as suture material.
  • Figures 16A and 16B depict intervertebral disc 15 comprising nucleus pulposus 20 and anulus fibrosis 10.
  • Figure 16A is an axial (transverse) view of the intervertebral disc.
  • a posterior lateral defect 16 in anulus fibrosis 10 has allowed a segment 30 of nucleus pulposus 20 to hemiate into an extra discal space 500.
  • hiterior aspect 32 and exterior aspect 34 are shown, as are the right 70' and left 70 transverse processes and posterior process 80.
  • Figure 16B is a sagittal section along the midline intervertebral disc.
  • a barrier or barrier means 12 can be placed into a space between the anulus 10 and the nucleus 20 proximate to the inner aspect 32 of defect 16, as depicted in Figures 17 and 18.
  • the space can be created by blunt dissection. Dissection can be achieved with a separate dissection instrument, with the barrier means 12 itself, or a combined dissection/barrier delivery tool 100. This space is preferably no larger than the barrier means such that the barrier means 12 can be in contact with both anulus 10 and nucleus 20.
  • the barrier means 12 preferably spans the defect 16 and extends along the interior aspect 36 of the anulus 10 until it contacts healthy tissues on all sides of the defect 16, or on a sufficient extent of adjacent healthy tissue to provide adequate support under load.
  • Healthy tissue may be non-diseased tissue and/or load bearing tissue, which may be micro-perforated or non-perforated.
  • the contacted tissues can include the anulus 10, cartilage overlying the vertebral endplates, and/or the endplates themselves.
  • the barrier means 12 comprises two components — a sealing means or sealing component 51 and an enlarging means or enlarging component 53, shown in Figures 21 A and 2 IB.
  • the sealing means 51 forms the periphery of the barrier 12 and has an interior cavity 17. There is at least one opening 8 leading into cavity 17 from the exterior of the sealing means 51.
  • Sealing means 51 is preferably compressible or collapsible to a dimension that can readily be inserted into the disc 15 tlirough a relatively small hole. This hole can be the defect 16 itself or a site remote from the defect 16.
  • the sealing means 51 is constracted from a material and is formed in such a manner as to resist the passage of fluids and other materials around sealing means 51 and tlirough the defect 16.
  • the sealing means 51 can be constracted from one or any number of a variety of materials including, but not limited to PTFE, e-PTFE, NylonTM, Marlex TM, high-density polyethylene, and/or collagen.
  • the thickness of the sealing component has been found to be optimal between about 0.001 inches (0.127 mm) and 0.063 inches (1.6 mm).
  • the enlarging means 53 can be sized to fit within cavity 17 of sealing means 51.
  • the enlarging means 53 can expand the sealing means 51 to an expanded state as it is passed into cavity 17.
  • One purpose of enlarging means 53 is to expand sealing means 51 to a size greater than that of the defect 16 such that the assembled barrier 12 prevents passage of material through the defect 16.
  • the enlarger 53 can further impart stiffness to the barrier 12 such that the barrier 12 resists the pressures within nucleus pulposus 20 and expulsion tlirough the defect 16.
  • the enlarging means 53 can be constracted from one or any number of materials including, but not limited to, silicon rabber, various plastics, stainless steel, nickel titanium alloys, or other metals. These materials may form a solid object, a hollow object, coiled springs or other suitable forms capable of filling cavity 17 within sealing means 51.
  • the sealing means 51, enlarging means 53, or the barrier means 12 constructs can further be affixed to tissues either surrounding the defect 16 or remote from the defect 16. hi the preferred embodiment, no aspect of a fixation means or fixation device or the barrier means 12 nor its components extend posterior to the disc 15 or into the extradiscal region 500, avoiding the risk of contacting and irritating the sensitive nerve tissues posterior to the disc 15.
  • the sealing means 51 is inserted into the disc 15 proximate the interior aspect 36 of the defect.
  • the sealing means 51 is then affixed to the tissues surrounding the defect using a suitable fixation means, such as suture or a soft- tissue anchor.
  • the fixation procedure is preferably performed from the interior of the sealing means cavity 17 as depicted in Figures 19 and 20.
  • a fixation delivery instrument 110 is delivered into cavity 17 through opening 8 in the sealing means 51.
  • Fixation devices 14 can then be deployed through a wall of the sealing means 53 into surrounding tissues. Once the fixation means 14 have been passed into surrounding tissue, the fixation delivery instrument 110 can be removed from the disc 15. This method eliminates the need for a separate entryway into the disc 15 for delivery of fixation means 14.
  • fixation means 14 can be delivered into one or any number of surrounding tissues including the superior 95 and inferior 95' vertebral bodies.
  • the enlarging means 53 can be inserted into cavity 17 of the sealing means 51 to further expand the barrier means 12 construct as well as increase its stiffness, as depicted in Figures 21 A and 21B.
  • the opening 8 into the sealing means 51 can then be closed by a suture or other means, although this is not a requirement of the present invention, hi certain cases, insertion of a separate enlarging means may not be necessary if adequate fixation of the sealing means 51 is achieved.
  • Another method of securing the barrier 12 to tissues is to affix the enlarging means 53 to tissues either surrounding or remote from the defect 16.
  • the enlarging means 53 can have an integral fixation region 4 that facilitates securing it to tissues as depicted in Figures 22A, 22B, 32A and 43B.
  • This fixation region 4 can extend exterior to sealing means 51 either through opening 8 or through a separate opening.
  • Fixation'region 4 can have a hole through which a fixation means or fixation device 14 can be passed.
  • the barrier 12 is affixed to at least one of the surrounding vertebral bodies (95 and 95') proximate to the defect using a bone anchor 14'.
  • the bone anchor 14' can be deployed into the vertebral bodies 50, 50' at some angle between 0E and 180E relative to a bone anchor deployment tool. As shown the bone anchor 14' is mounted at 90E relative to the bone anchor deployment tool. Alternatively, the enlarging means 53 itself can have an integral fixation device 14 located at a site or sites along its length. [0180] Another method of securing the barrier means 12 is to insert the barrier means 12 through the defect 16 or another opening into the disc 15, position it proximate to the interior aspect 36 of the defect 16, and pass at least one fixation means 14 tlirough the anulus 10 and into the barrier 12.
  • the fixation means 14 can be darts 15 and are first passed partially into anulus 10 within a fixation device 120, such as a hollow needle.
  • fixation means 25 can be advanced into the barrier means 12 and fixation device 120 removed.
  • Fixation means 25 preferably have two ends, each with a means to prevent movement of that end of the fixation device.
  • the fixation means can be lodged in both the barrier 12 and anulus fibrosis 10 without any aspect of fixation means 25 exterior to the disc in the extradiscal region 500.
  • the barrier (or "patch") 12 can be placed between two neighboring layers 33, 37 (lamellae) of the anulus 10 on either or both sides of the defect 16 as depicted in Figures 24 A and 24B.
  • Figure 24A shows an axial view while 24B shows a sagittal cross section. Such positioning spans the defect 16.
  • the barrier means 12 can be secured using the methods outlined.
  • a dissecting tool can be used to form an opening extending circumferentially 31 within the anulus fibrosis such that the barrier can be inserted into the opening.
  • the barrier itself can have a dissecting edge such that it can be driven at least partially into the sidewalls of defect 16, annulotomy 416, access hole 417 or opening in the anulus.
  • This process can make use of the naturally layered structure in the anulus in which adjacent layers 33, 37 are defined by a circumferentially extending boundary 35 between the layers.
  • Another embodiment of the barrier 12 is a patch having a length, oriented along the circumference of the disc, which is substantially greater than its height, which is oriented along the distance separating the surrounding vertebral bodies.
  • a barrier 12 having a length greater than its height is illustrated in Figure 25. The barrier 12 can be positioned across the defect 16 as well as the entirety of the posterior aspect of the anulus fibrosis 10.
  • the barrier 12 can be used in conjunction with an augmentation device 11 inserted within the anulus 10.
  • the augmentation device 11 can include separate augmentation devices 42 as shown in Figure 26.
  • the augmentation device 11 can also be a single augmentation device 44 and can form part of the barrier 12 as barrier region 300, coiled within the anulus fibrosis 10, as shown in Figure 27.
  • the barrier or patch 12 may be used as part of a method to a ⁇ gment the intervertebral disc, hi one aspect of this method, augmentation material or devices are inserted into the disc through a defect (either naturally occurring or surgically generated). Many suitable augmentation materials and devices are discussed above and in the prior art. As depicted in Figure 26, the barrier means is then inserted to aid in closing the defect and/or to aid in transferring load from the augmentation materials/devices to healthy tissues surrounding the defect. In another aspect of this method, the barrier means is an integral component to an augmentation device.
  • the augmentation portion may comprise a length of elastic material that can be inserted linearly through a defect in the anulus.
  • a region 300 of the length forms the barrier means of some embodiments of the present invention and can be positioned proximate to the interior aspect of the defect once the nuclear space is adequately filled. Barrier region 300 may then be affixed to surrounding tissues such as the AF and/or the neighboring vertebral bodies using any of the methods and devices described above.
  • Figures 28A and 28B illustrate axial and sagittal sections, respectively, of an alternate configuration of an augmentation device 38.
  • FIGS 29A-D illustrate the deployment of a barrier 12 from an entry site 800 remote from the defect in the anulus fibrosis 10.
  • Figure 29A shows insertion instrument 130 with a distal end positioned within the disc space occupied by nucleus pulposus 20.
  • Figure 29B depicts delivery catheter 140 exiting the distal end of insertion instrument 130 with barrier 12 on its distal end.
  • Barrier 12 is positioned across the interior aspect of the defect 16.
  • Figure 29C depicts the use of an expandable barrier 12' wherein delivery catheter 140 is used to expand the barrier 12' with balloon 150 on its distal end.
  • Balloon 150 may exploit heat to further adhere barrier 12' to surrounding tissue.
  • Figure 29D depicts removal of balloon 150 and delivery catheter 140 from the disc space leaving expanded barrier means 12' positioned across defect 16.
  • Another method of securing the barrier means 12 is to adhere it to surrounding tissues tlirough the application of heat, hi this embodiment, the barrier means 12 includes a sealing means 51 comprised of a thermally adherent material that adheres to surrounding tissues upon the application of heat.
  • the thermally adherent material can include thermoplastic, collagen, or a similar material.
  • the sealing means 51 can further comprise a separate structural material that adds strength to the thermally adherent material, such as a woven NylonTM or Marlex rM .
  • This thermally adherent sealing means preferably has an interior cavity 17 and at least one opening 8 leading from the exterior of the barrier means into cavity 17.
  • a thermal device can be attached to the insertion instrument shown in Figures 29C and 29D.
  • the insertion instrument 130 having a thermal device can be inserted into cavity 17 and used to heat sealing means 51 and surrounding tissues.
  • This device can be a simple thermal element, such as a resistive heating coil, rod or wire. It can further be a number of electrodes capable of heating the barrier means and surrounding tissue through the application of radio frequency (RF) energy.
  • the thermal device can further be a balloon 150, 150', as shown in Figure 47, capable of both heating and expanding the barrier means.
  • Balloon 150, 150' can either be inflated with a heated fluid or have electrodes located about its surface to heat the barrier means with RF energy. Balloon 150, 150' is deflated and removed after heating the sealing means. These thermal methods and devices achieve the goal of adhering the sealing means to the AF and NP and potentially other surrounding tissues. The application of heat can further aid the procedure by killing small nerves within the AF, by causing the defect to shrink, or by causing cross- linking and/or shrinking of surrounding tissues.
  • An expander or enlarging means 53 can also be an integral component of barrier 12 inserted within sealing means 51.
  • a separate enlarging means 53 can be inserted into the interior cavity of the barrier means to either enlarge the barrier 12 or add stiffness to its structure.
  • Such an enlarging means is preferably similar in make-up and design to those described above. Use of an enlarging means may not be necessary in some cases and is not a required component of this method.
  • the barrier means 12 shown in Figure 25 preferably has a primary curvature or gentle curve along the length of the patch or barrier 12 that allows it to conform to the inner circumference of the AF 10. This curvature may have a single radius R as shown in Figures 44A and 44B or may have multiple curvatures. The curvature can be fabricated into the barrier 12 and/or any of its components.
  • the sealing means can be made without an inherent curvature while the enlarging means can have a primary curvature along its length.
  • the overall barrier means assembly takes on the primary curvature of the enlarging means.
  • This modularity allows enlarging means with specific curvatures to be fabricated for defects occurring in various regions of the anulus fibrosis.
  • the cross section of the barrier 12 can be any of a number of shapes. Each embodiment exploits a sealing means 51 and an enlarging means 53 that may further add stiffness to the overall barrier construct.
  • Figures 30A and 30B show an elongated cylindrical embodiment with enlarging means 53 located about the long axis of the device.
  • Figures 31A and 3 IB depict a barrier means comprising an enlarging means 53 with a central cavity 49.
  • the concave portion of the barrier means preferably faces nucleus pulposus 20 while the convex surface faces the defect 16, annulotomy 416, or access hole 417 and the im er aspect of the anulus fibrosis 10.
  • the 'C shape as shown in Figure 33 A is the preferred shape of the barrier wherein the convex portion of the patch rests against the interior aspect of the AF while the concave portion faces the NP.
  • the barrier or patch 12 serves to partially encapsulate the nucleus puposus 20 by conforming to the gross morphology of the imier surface of the anulus 10 and presenting a concave or cupping surface toward the nucleus 20.
  • the upper and lower portions of this 'C shaped barrier means are positioned against the vertebral endplates or overlying cartilage.
  • FIGS 34 through 41 depict various enlarging or expansion devices 53 that can be employed to aid in expanding a sealing element 51 within the intervertebral disc 15.
  • Each embodiment can be covered by, coated with, or cover the sealing element 51.
  • the sealing means 51 can further be woven tlirough the expansion means 53.
  • the sealing element 51 or membrane can be a sealer winch can prevent flow of a material from within the anulus fibrosis of the intervertebral disc through a defect in the anulus fibrosis.
  • the material within the anulus can include nucleus pulposus or a prosthetic augmentation device, such as a hydrogel.
  • Figures 34 through 38 depict alternative patterns to that illustrated in Figure 33 A.
  • Figure 33 A shows the expansion devices 53 within the sealing means 51.
  • the sealing means can alternatively be secured to one or another face (concave or convex) of the expansion means 53. This can have advantages in reducing the overall volume of the barrier means 12, simplifying insertion through a narrow cannula.
  • the sealing means 51 can be formed from a material that resists ingrowth such as expanded polytetraflouroethylene (e-PTFE).
  • e-PTFE expanded polytetraflouroethylene
  • the expansion means 53 can be constracted of a metal or polymer that encourages ingrowth, hi several embodiments, if the e-PTFE sealing means 51 is secured to the concave face of the expansion means 53, tissue can grow into the expansion means 53 from outside of the disc 15, helping to secure the barrier means 12 in place and seal against egress of materials from within the disc 15.
  • the expansion means 53 shown in Figure 33 A can be inserted into the sealing means 51 once the sealing means 51 is within the disc 15.
  • the expansion means 53 and sealing means 51 can be integral components of the barrier means 12 that can be inserted as a unit into the disc.
  • the patterns shown in Figures 34 tlirough 38 can preferably be formed from a relatively thin sheet of material.
  • the material may be a polymer, metal, or gel, however, the superelastic properties of nickel titanium alloy (NITINOL) makes this metal particularly advantageous in this application.
  • Sheet thickness can generally be in a range of about 0.1 mm to about 0.6 mm and for certain embodiments has been found to be optimal if between about 0.003" to about 0.015" (0.0762 mm to 0.381 mm), for the thickness to provide adequate expansion force to maintain contact between the sealing means 51 and surrounding vertebral endplates.
  • FIG. 34 shows an embodiment of a non-axisymmetric expander 153 having a superior edge 166 and an inferior edge 168.
  • the expander 153 can form a frame of barrier 12.
  • This embodiment comprises dissecting surfaces or ends 160, radial elements or fingers 162 and a central strut 164.
  • the circular shape of the dissecting ends 160 aids in dissecting through the nucleus pulposus 20 and/or along or between an inner surface of the anulus fibrosis 10.
  • the distance between the left-most and right-most points on the dissecting ends is the expansion means length 170.
  • This length 170 preferably lies along the inner perimeter of the posterior anulus following implantation.
  • the expander length 170 can be as short as about 3 mm and as long as the entire interior perimeter of the anulus fibrosis.
  • the superior-inferior height of these dissecting ends 160 is preferably similar to or larger than the posterior disc height.
  • This embodiment employs a multitude of fingers 162 to aid in holding a flexible sealer or membrane against the superior and inferior vertebral endplates.
  • the distance between the superior-most point of the superior finger and the inferior-most point on the inferior finger is the expansion means height 172. This height 172 is preferably greater than the disc height at the inner surface of the posterior anulus.
  • the greater height 172 of the expander 153 allows the fingers 162 to deflect along the superior and inferior vertebral endplates, enhancing the seal of the barrier means 12 against egress of material from within the disc 15.
  • the spacing between the fingers 162 along the expander length 170 can be tailored to provide a desired stiffness of the expansion means 153. Greater spacing between any two neighboring fingers 162 can further be employed to insure that the fingers 170 do not touch if the expansion means 153 is required to talce a bend along its length.
  • the central strut 164 can connect the fingers and dissecting ends and preferably lies along the inner surface of the anulus 10 when seated within the disc 15.
  • FIG. 35 depicts an alternative embodiment to the expander 153 of Figure 34. Openings or slots 174 can be included along the central strut 164. These slots 174 promote bending of the expander 153 and fingers 162 along a central line 176 connecting the centers of the dissecting ends 160. Such central flexibility has been found to aid against superior or inferior migration of the barrier means or barrier 12 when the barrier 12 has not been secured to surrounding tissues.
  • Figures 34B and 34C depict different perspective views of a preferred embodiment of the expander/frame 153 within an intervertebral disc 15.
  • Expander 53 is in its expanded condition and lies along and/or within the posterior wall 21 and extends around the lateral walls 23 of the anulus fibrosis 10.
  • the superior 166 and inferior 168 facing fingers 162 of expander 153 extend along the vertebral endplates (not shown) and/or the cartilage overlying the endplates.
  • the frame 153 can talce on a 3-D concave shape in this preferred position with the concavity generally directed toward the interior of the intervertebral disc and specifically a region occupied by the nucleus pulposus 20. [0200]
  • the bending stiffness of expander 153 can resist migration of the implant from this preferred position within the disc 15.
  • the stiffer this section of expander 153 is, the higher the forces necessary to force it around these comers and the less likely it is to migrate in this direction.
  • This principle was also used in this embodiment to resist migration of fingers 162 away from the vertebral endplates:
  • the slots 174 cut along the length of expander 153 create a central flexibility that encourages expander 153 to bend along an axis running through these slots as the posterior disc height increases and decreased during flexion and extension, h order for the fingers 162 to migrate away from the endplate, this central flexible region must move away from the posterior anulus 21 and toward an endplate. This motion is resisted by the greater stiffness of expander 153 in the areas directly inferior and superior to this central flexible region.
  • the expander 153 is preferably covered by a membrane that acts to further restrict the movement of materials tlirough the frame and toward the outer periphery of the anulus fibrosis.
  • Figure 36 depicts an embodiment of the expander 153 of Figure 33 A with an enlarged central strut 164 and a plurality of slots 174.
  • This central strut 164 can have a uniform stiffness against superior-inferior 166 and 168 bending as shown in this embodiment.
  • the strut 164 can alternatively have a varying stiffness along its height 178 to either promote or resist bending at a given location along the inner surface of the anulus 10.
  • Figures 37A-C depict a further embodiment of the frame or expander 153.
  • This embodiment employs a central lattice 180 consisting of multiple, fine interconnected struts 182.
  • a lattice 180 can provide a structure that minimizes bulging of the sealing means 51 under intradiscal pressures.
  • the orientation and location of these struts 182 have been designed to give the barrier 12 a bend-axis along the central area of the expander height 172.
  • the struts 182 support inferior 168 and superior 166 fingers 162 similar to previously described embodiments. However, these fingers 162 can have varying dimensions and stiffness along the length of the barrier 12. Such fingers 162 can be useful for helping the sealer 51 conform to uneven endplate geometries.
  • Figure 37B illustrates the curved cross section 184 of the expander 153 of Figure 37A.
  • This curve 184 can be an arc segment of a circle as shown.
  • the cross section can be an ellipsoid segment or have a multitude of arc segments of different radii and centers.
  • Figure 37C is a perspective view showing the tliree dimensional shape of the expander 153 of Figures 37A and 37B.
  • the embodiment of the frame 153 as shown in Figures 37A-C can also be employed without the use of a covering membrane.
  • the nucleus pulposus of many patients with low back pain or disc herniation can degenerate to a state in which the material properties of the nucleus cause it to behave much more like a solid than a gel.
  • the water content of the nucleus declines from roughly 88%) to less than 75%. As this occurs, there is an increase in the cross linking of collagen within the disc resulting in a greater solidity of the nucleus.
  • the pore size or the largest open area of any given gap in the lattice depicted in Figures 37A-37C is between about 0.05mm 2 (7.75xl0 "5 in 2 ) and about 0.75mm 2 (1.16xl0 "3 in 2 ), the nucleus pulposus is unable to extrude through the lattice at pressures generated within the disc (between about 250 KPa and about 1.8 MPa).
  • the preferred pore size has been found to be approximately 0.15 mm 2 (2.33xl0 "4 in 2 ). This pore size can be used with any of the disclosed embodiments of the expander or any other expander that falls within the scope of embodiments of the invention to prevent movement of nucleus toward the outer periphery of the disc without the need for an additional membrane.
  • the membrane thickness is preferably in a range of about 0.025 mm to about 2.5 mm.
  • Figure 38 depicts an expander 153 similar to that of Figure 37A without fingers.
  • the expander 153 includes a central lattice 180 consisting of multiple struts 182.
  • Figures 39 tlirough 41 depict another embodiment of the expander 153 of some embodiments of the present invention.
  • FIG. 39 depicts an embodiment of a tubular expander 154.
  • the superior 166 and inferior surfaces 168 of the tubular expander 154 can deploy against the superior and inferior vertebral endplates, respectively.
  • the distance 186 between the superior 166 and inferior 168 surfaces of the expander 154 are preferably equal to or greater than the posterior disc height at the inner surface of the anulus 10.
  • This embodiment has an anulus face 188 and nucleus face 190 as shown in Figures 39B, 39C and 39D.
  • the anulus face 188 can be covered by the sealer 51 from the superior 166 to inferior 168 surface of the expander 154.
  • This face 188 lies against the imier surface of the anulus 10 in its deployed position and can prevent egress of materials from within the disc 15.
  • the primary purpose of the nucleus face 190 is to prevent migration of the expander 154 within the disc 15.
  • the struts 192 that form the nucleus face 190 can project anteriorly into the nucleus 20 when the barrier 12 is positioned across the posterior wall of the anulus 10. This anterior projection can resist rotation of the tubular expansion means 154 about its long axis.
  • the struts 192 can further prevent migration around the circumference of the disc 15.
  • the struts 192 can be spaced to provide nuclear gaps 194. These gaps 194 can encourage the flow of nucleus pulposus 20 into the interior of the expander 154. This flow can insure full expansion of the barrier 12 within the disc 15 during deployment.
  • the embodiments of Figures 39, 40 and 41 vary by their cross-sectional shape.
  • Figure 39 has a circular cross section 196 as seen in Figure 39C. If the superior- inferior height 186 of the expander 154 is greater than that of the disc 15, this circular cross section 196 can defonn into an oval when deployed, as the endplates of the vertebrae compress the expander 154.
  • the embodiment of the expander 154 shown in Figure 40 is preformed into an oval shape 198 shown in Figure 40C. Compression by the endplates can exaggerate the unstrained oval 198. This oval 198 can provide greater stability against rotation about a long axis of the expander 154.
  • the embodiment of Figure 41B, 41C and 41D depict an 'egg-shaped' cross section 202, as shown in Figure 41C, that can allow congraity between the curvature of the expander 154 and the inner wall of posterior anulus 10. Any of a variety of alternate cross sectional shapes can be employed to obtain a desired fit or expansion force without deviating from the spirit of the present invention.
  • Figures 40E, 40F, and 401 depict the expander 154 of Figures 40A-D having a sealing means 51 covering the exterior surface of the anulus face 188. This sealing means 51 can be held against the endplates and the inner surface of the posterior anulus by the expander 154 in its deployed state.
  • Figures 40G and 40H depict the expander 154 of Figure 40B with a sealer 51 covering the interior surface of the anulus face 188. This position of the sealer 51 can allow the expander 154 to contact both the vertebral endplates and inner surface of the posterior anulus. This can promote ingrowth of tissue into the expander 154 from outside the disc 15.
  • sealer 51 that cover all or part of the expander 154 can also be employed without deviating from the scope of the present invention.
  • the expander 154 can also have a small pore size thereby allowing retention of a material such as a nucleus pulposus, for example, without the need for a sealer as a covering.
  • Figures 42A-D depict cross sections of a preferred embodiment of sealing means 51 and enlarging means 53.
  • Sealing means 51 has internal cavity 17 and opening 8 leading from its outer surface into internal cavity 17.
  • Enlarger 53 can be inserted through opening 8 and into internal cavity 17.
  • Figures 43A and 43B depict an alternative configuration of enlarger 53.
  • Fixation region 4 extends tlirough opening 8 in sealing means 51.
  • Fixation region 4 has a through-hole that can facilitate fixation of enlarger 53 to tissues surrounding defect 16.
  • Figures 44A and 44B depict an alternative shape of the barrier.
  • sealing means 51, enlarger 53, or both have a curvature with radius R. This curvature can be used in any embodiment of the present invention and may aid in conforming to the curved inner circumference of anulus fibrosis 10.
  • Figure 45 is a section of a device used to affix sealing means 51 to tissues surrounding a defect, h this figure, sealing means 51 would be positioned across interior aspect 50 of defect 16. The distal end of device 110' would be inserted through defect 16 and opening 8 into the interior cavity 17.
  • fixation dart 25 has been passed from device 110', through a wall of sealing means 51 and into tissues surrounding sealing means 51.
  • fixation dart 25 is about to be passed tlirough a wall of sealing means 51 by advancing pusher 111 relative to device 110' in the direction of the arrow.
  • Figure 46 depicts the use of themial device 200 to heat sealing means 51 and adhere it to tissues surrounding a defect, h this figure, sealing means 51 would be positioned across the interior aspect 36 of a defect 16. The distal end of thermal device 200 would be inserted through the defect and opening 8 into interior cavity 17.
  • thermal device 200 employs at its distal end resistive heating element 210 comiected to a voltage source by wires 220.
  • Covering 230 is a non-stick surface such as Teflon tubing that ensures the ability to remove device 200 from interior cavity 17.
  • device 200 would be used to heat first one half, and then the other half of sealing means 51.
  • Figure 47 depicts an expandable thermal element, such as a balloon, that can be used to adhere sealing means 51 to tissues surrounding a defect. As in Figure 18, the distal end of device 130 can be inserted through the defect and opening 8 into interior cavity 17, with balloon 150' on the distal end device 130 in a collapsed state. Balloon 150' is then inflated to expanded state 150, expanding sealing means 51.
  • Expanded balloon 150 can heat sealing means 51 and surrounding tissues by inflating it with a heated fluid or by employing RF electrodes.
  • device 130 can be used to expand and heat first one half, then the other half of sealing means 51.
  • Figure 48 depicts an alternative embodiment to device 130. Tins device employs an elongated, flexible balloon 150' that can be inserted into and completely fill internal cavity 17 of sealing means 51 prior to inflation to an expanded state 150. Using this embodiment, inflation and heating of sealing means 51 can be performed in one step.
  • Figures 49 A through 49G illustrate a method of implanting an intradiscal implant.
  • An intradiscal implant system consists of an intradiscal implant 400, a delivery device or cannula 402, an advancer 404 and at least one control filament 406.
  • the intradiscal implant 400 is loaded into the delivery cannula 402 which has a proximal end 408 and a distal end 410.
  • Figure 49 A illustrates the distal end 410 advanced into the disc 15 tlirough an annulotomy 416.
  • This annulotomy 416 can be tlirough any portion of the anulus 10, but is preferably at a site proximate to a desired, final implant location.
  • the implant 400 is then pushed into the disc 15 through the distal end 410 of the cannula 402 in a direction that is generally away from the desired, final implant location as shown in Figure 49B.
  • the implant 400 can be pulled into the desired implant location by pulling on the control filament 406 as shown in Figure 49C.
  • the control filament 406 can be secured to the implant 400 at any location on or within the implant 400, but is preferably secured at least at a site 414 or sites on a distal portion 412 of the implant 400, e.g., that portion that first exits the delivery cannula 402 when advanced into the disc 15.
  • These site or sites 414 are generally furthest from the desired, final implant location once the implant has been fully expelled from the interior of the delivery cannula 402.
  • Pulling on the control filament 406 causes the implant 400 to move toward the annulotomy 416.
  • the distal end 410 of the delivery cannula 402 can be used to direct the proximal end 420 of the implant 400 (that portion of the implant 400 that is last to be expelled from the delivery cannula 402) away from the annulotomy 416 and toward an inner aspect of the anulus 10 nearest the desired implant location.
  • the advancer 404 can be used to position the proximal end of the implant toward an inner aspect of the anulus 20 near the implant location, as shown in Figure 49E.
  • the implant 400 can be any one of the following (including a combination of two or more of the following): nucleus replacement device, nucleus augmentation device, anulus augmentation device, anulus replacement device, the barrier of the present invention or any of its components, drag carrier device, carrier device seeded with living cells, or a device that stimulates or supports fusion of the surrounding vertebra.
  • the implant 400 can be a membrane which prevents the flow of a material from within the anulus fibrosis of an intervertebral disc through a defect in the disc.
  • the material within the anulus fibrosis can be, for example, a nucleus pulposus or a prosthetic augmentation device, such as hydrogel.
  • the membrane can be a sealer.
  • the implant 400 can be wholly or partially rigid or wholly or partially flexible. It can have a solid portion or portions that contain a fluid material. It can comprise a single or multitude of materials. These materials can include metals, polymers, gels and can be in solid or woven form.
  • the implant 400 can either resist or promote tissue ingrowth, whether fibrous or bony.
  • the cannula 402 can be any tubular device capable of advancing the implant 400 at least partially through the anulus 10. It can be made of any suitable biocompatible material including various known metals and polymers. It can be wholly or partially rigid or flexible. It can be circular, oval, polygonal, or irregular in cross section. It must have an opening at least at its distal end 410, but can have other openings in various locations along its length.
  • the advancer 404 can be rigid or flexible, and have one of a variety of cross sectional shapes either like or unlike the delivery cannula 402. It may be a solid or even a column of incompressible fluid, so long as it is stiff enough to advance the implant 400 into the disc 15.
  • the advancer 404 can be contained entirely within the cannula 402 or can extend through a wall or end of the cannula to facilitate manipulation.
  • Advancement of the implant 400 can be assisted by various levers, gears, screws and other secondary assist devices to minimize the force required by the surgeon to advance the implant 400. These secondary devices can further give the user greater control over the rate and extent of advancement into the disc 15.
  • the guide filament 406 may be a string, rod, plate, or other elongate object that can be secured to and move with the implant 400 as it is advanced into the disc 15. It can be constracted from any of a variety of metals or polymers or combination thereof and can be flexible or rigid along all or part of its length. It can be secured to a secondary object 418 or device at its end opposite that which is secured to the implant 400. This secondary device 418 can include the advancer 404 or other object or device that assists the user in manipulating the filament.
  • the filament 406 can be releasably secured to the implant 400, as shown in Figure 49G or permanently affixed. The filament 406 can be looped around or through the implant.
  • Such a loop can either be cut or have one end pulled until the other end of the loop releases the implant 400. It may be bonded to the implant 400 using adhesive, welding, or a secondary securing means such as a screw, staple, dart, etc.
  • the filament 406 can further be an elongate extension of the implant material itself. If not removed following placement of the implant, the filament 406 can be used to secure the implant 400 to surrounding tissues such as the neighboring anulus 10, vertebral endplates, or vertebral bodies either directly or through the use of a dart, screw, staple, or other suitable anchor.
  • Multiple guide filaments can be secured to the implant 400 at various locations, hi one preferred embodiment, a first or distal 422 and a second or proximal 424 guide filament are secured to an elongate implant 400 at or near its distal 412 and proximal 420 ends at attaclnnent sites 426 and 428, respectively. These ends 412 and 420 correspond to the first and last portions of the implant 400, respectively, to be expelled from the delivery cannula 402 when ad ⁇ anced into the disc 15.
  • This double guide filament system allows the implant 400 to be positioned in the same manner described above in the single filament technique, and illustrated in Figures 50A-C.
  • Tins has numerous advantages in various implantation procedures. This step may reduce the risk of hemiation of either nucleus pulposus 20 or the implant itself. It may aid in sealing the disc, as well as preserving disc pressure and the natural function of the disc. It may encourage ingrowth of fibrous tissue from outside the disc into the implant. It may further allow the distal end of the implant to rest against anulus further from the defect created by the annulotomy.
  • both ends of an elongate implant can be secured to the disc or vertebral tissues.
  • Both the first 422 and second 424 guide filaments can be simultaneously tensioned, as shown in Figure 50E, to ensure proper positioning of the implant 400 within the anulus 10. Once the implant 400 is placed across the annulotomy, the first 422 and second 424 guide filaments can be removed from the input 400, as shown in Figure 50F. Additional control filaments and securing sites may further assist implantation and/or fixation of the intradiscal implants.
  • an implant guide 430 may be employed to aid directing the implant 400 through the annulotomy 416, through the nucleus pulposus 10, and/or along the inner aspect of the anulus 10.
  • This implant guide 430 can aid in the procedure by dissecting through tissue, adding stiffness to the implant construct, reducing trauma to the anulus or other tissues that can be caused by a stiff or abrasive implant, providing 3-D control of the implants orientation during implantation, expanding an expandable implant, or temporarily imparting a shape to the implant that is beneficial during implantation.
  • the implant guide 430 can be affixed to either the advancer 404 or the implant 406 themselves.
  • the implant guide 430 is secured to the implant 400 by the first 424 and second 426 guide filaments of the first 426 and the second 428 attachment sites, respectively.
  • the guide filaments 424 and 426 may pass through or around the implant guide 430.
  • the implant guide 430 may be a thin, flat sheet of biocompatible metal with holes passing tlirough its surface proximate to the site or sites 426 and 428 at which the guide filaments 422 and 424 are secured to the implant 400. These holes allow passage of the securing filament 422 and 424 through the implant guide 430.
  • Such an elongated sheet may ran along the implant 400 and extend beyond its distal end 412.
  • the distal end of the implant guide 430 may be shaped to help dissect through the nucleus 10 and deflect off of the anulus 10 as the implant 400 is advanced into the disc 15.
  • an implant guide 430 can be used to control rotational stability of the implant 400. It may also be used to retract the implant 400 from the disc 15 should this become necessary.
  • the implant guide 430 may also extend beyond the proximal tip 420 of the implant 400 to aid in dissecting across or tlirough the anulus 10 proximate to the desired implantation site.
  • the implant guide 430 is releasable from the implant 400 following or during implantation. This release may be coordinated with the release of the guide filaments 422 and 424.
  • the implant guide 430 may further be able to slide along the guide filaments 422 and 424 while these filaments are secured to the implant 400.
  • Various embodiments of the barrier 12 or implant 400 can be secured to tissues within the intervertebral disc 15 or surrounding vertebrae. It can be advantageous to secure the barrier means 12 in a limited number of sites while still insuring that larger surfaces of the barrier 12 or implant juxtapose the tissue to which the barrier 12 is secured. This is particularly advantageous in forming a sealing engagement with surrounding tissues.
  • Figures 53-57 illustrate barriers 12 having stiffening elements 300. The barrier 12 can incorporate stiffening elements 300 that ran along a length of the implant required to be in sealing engagement.
  • stiffening elements 300 can be one of a variety of shapes including, but not limited to, plates 302, rods 304, or coils. These elements are preferably stiffer than the surrounding barrier 12 and can impart their stiffness to the surrounding barrier. These stiffening elements 300 can be located within an interior cavity formed by the barrier. They can further be imbedded in or secured to the barrier 12. [0233] Each stiffening element can aid in securing segments of the barrier 12 to surrounding tissues.
  • the stiffening elements can have parts 307, including through-holes, notches, or other indentations for example, to facilitate fixation of the stiffening element 300 to surrounding tissues by any of a variety of fixation devices 306.
  • fixation devices 306 can include screws, darts, dowels, or other suitable means capable of holding the barrier 12 to surrounding tissue.
  • the fixation devices 306 can be connected either directly to the stiffening element 300 or indirectly using an intervening length of suture, cable, or other filament for example.
  • the fixation device 306 can further be secured to the barrier 12 near the stiffening element 300 without direct contact with the stiffening element 300.
  • the fixation device 306 can be secured to or near the stiffening element 300 at opposing ends of the length of the barrier 12 required to be in sealing engagement with surrounding tissues.
  • fixation devices 306 can be secured to or near the stiffening element 300 at a readily accessible location that may not be at these ends, hi any barrier 12 embodiment with an interior cavity 17 and an opening 8 leading thereto, the fixation sites may be proximal to the opening 8 to allow passage of the fixation device 306 and various instruments that may be required for their implantation.
  • Figures 53 A and 53B illustrate one embodiment of a barrier 12 incorporating the use of a stiffening element 300.
  • the barrier 12 can be a plate and screw barrier 320.
  • the stiffening element 300 consists of two fixation plates, superior 310 and inferior 312, an example of which is illustrated in Figures 54 A and 54B with two parts 308 passing tlirough each plate.
  • the parts 308 are located proximal to an opening 8 leading into an interior cavity 17 of the barrier 12.
  • These parts 8 allow passage of a fixation device 306 such as a bone screw.
  • These screws can be used to secure the barrier means 12 to a superior 50 and inferior 50' vertebra.
  • the fixation plates 310, 312 compress the intervening sealing means against the endplate along the superior and inferior surfaces of the barrier 12. This can aid in creating a sealing engagement with the vertebral endplates and prevent egress of materials from within the disc 15.
  • FIGs 55A and 55B illustrate another embodiment of a barrier 12 having stiffening elements 300.
  • the barrier 12 can be an anchor and rod barrier 322.
  • the stiffening elements 300 consist of two fixation rods 304, an example of which is shown in Figures 56A and 56B, imbedded within the barrier 12.
  • the rods 304 can include a superior rod 314 and an inferior rod 316. Sutures 318 can be passed around these rods 314 and 316 and through the barrier means 10.
  • FIG. 57 illustrates the anchor and rod barrier 322, described above, with fixation devices 306 placed at opposing ends of each fixation rod 316 and 318.
  • the suture 18 on the left side of the superior rod 318 has yet to be tied.
  • Various methods may be employed to decrease the forces necessary to maneuver the barrier 12 into a position along or within the lamellae of the anulus fibrosis 10.
  • Figures 58A, 58B, 59A and 59B depict two preferred methods of clearing a path for the barrier 12.
  • Figures 58 A and 58B depict one such method and an associated dissector device 454.
  • the assumed desired position of the implant is along the posterior anulus 452.
  • a hairpin dissector 454 can be passed along the intended implantation site of the implant.
  • the hairpin dissector 454 can have a hairpin dissector component 460 having a free end 458.
  • the dissector can also have an advancer 464 to position the dissector component 460 within the disc 15.
  • the dissector 454 can be inserted through cannula 456 into an opening 462 in the anulus 10 along an access path directed anteriorly or anterior-medially. Once a free-end 458 of the dissector component 460 is within the disc 15, the free-end 458 moves slightly causing the hairpin to open, such that the dissector component 460 resists returning into the cannula 456. This opening 462 can be caused by pre-forming the dissector to the opened state. The hairpin dissector component 460 can then be pulled posteriorly, causing the dissector component 460 to open, further driving the free-end 458 along the posterior anulus 458. This motion clears a path for the insertion of any of the implants disclosed in the present invention.
  • the body of dissector component 460 is preferably formed from an elongated sheet of metal. Suitable metals include various spring steels or nickel titanium alloys. It can alternatively be formed from wires or rods.
  • Figures 59A and 59B depict another method and associated dissector device 466 suitable for clearing a path for implant insertion.
  • the dissector device 466 is shown in cross section and consists of a dissector component 468, an outer cannula 470 and an advancer or inner push rod 472.
  • a curved passage or slot 474 is formed into an intradiscal tip 476 of outer cannula 470.
  • This passage or slot 474 acts to deflect the tip of dissector component 468 in a path that is roughly parallel to the lamellae of the anulus fibrosis 10 as the dissector component 468 is advanced into the disc 15 by the advancer.
  • the dissector component 468 is preferably formed from a superelastic nickel titanium alloy, but can be constracted of any material with suitable rigidity and strain characteristics to allow such deflection without significant plastic deformation.
  • the dissector component 468 can be formed from an elongated sheet, rods, wires or the like. It can be used to dissect between the anulus 10 and nucleus 20, or to dissect between layers of the anulus 10.
  • Figures 60A-C depict an alternate dissector component 480 of Figures 59A and 59B. Only the intradiscal tip 476 of device 460 and regions proximal thereto are shown in these figures.
  • a push-rod 472 similar to that shown in Figure 59A can be employed to advance dissector 480 into the disc 15.
  • Dissector 480 can include an elongated sheet 482 with superiorly and inferiorly extending blades (or "wings") 484 and 486, respectively.
  • This sheet 482 is preferably formed from a metal with a large elastic strain range such as spring steel or nickel titanium alloy.
  • the sheet 482 can have a proximal end 488 and a distal end 490.
  • the distal end 490 can have a flat portion which can be flexible.
  • a step portion 494 can be located between the distal end 490 and the proximal end 488.
  • the proximal end 488 can have a curved shape.
  • the proximal end can also include blades 484 and 486.
  • passage or slot 478 directs the dissector component 480 in a direction roughly parallel to the posterior anulus (90 degrees to the central axis of sleeve 470 in this case) in a manner similar to that described for the embodiment in Figures 59A and 59B.
  • Wings 484 and 486 open as they exit the end of sleeve 470 and expand toward the vertebral endplates.
  • FIGS 61A-61D illustrate a method of implanting a disc implant.
  • a disc implant 552 is inserted into a delivery device 550.
  • the delivery device 550 has a proximal end 556 and a distal end 558.
  • the distal end 558 of the delivery device 550 is inserted into an annulotomy illustrated in Figure 61A.
  • the amiulotomy is preferably located at a site within the anulus 10 that is proximate to a desired, final implant 552 location.
  • the implant 400 is then deployed by being inserted into the disc 15 through the distal end 558 of the delivery device 550.
  • Preferably the implant is forced away from the final implant location, as shown in Figure 6 IB.
  • An implant guide 560 can be used to position the implant 400.
  • an augmentation material 7 can be injected into the disc 15. Injection of augmentation after deployment is illustrated in Figure 61C.
  • the augmentation material 7 can include a hydrogel or collagen, for example.
  • the delivery device 550 is removed from the disc 15 and a separate tube is inserted into the annulotomy to inject the flowable augmentation material 7.
  • the distal end 558 of the delivery device 550 can remain within the annulotomy and the fluid augmentation material 554 injected through the delivery device 550.
  • the delivery device 550 is removed from the annulotomy and the intradiscal implant 400 is positioned over the annulotomy in the final implant location, as shown in Figure 6 ID.
  • the implant 400 can be positioned using control filaments described above.
  • a disc environment with a degenerated or lesioned anulus cannot generally support the load transmission from either the native nucleus or from prosthetic augmentation, hi many cases, nuclear augmentation materials 7 bulge through the anulus defects, extrude from the disc, or apply pathologically high load to damaged regions of the anulus. Accordingly, in one aspect of the current invention, damaged areas of the anulus are protected by shunting the load from the nucleus 20 or augmentation materials 7 to healthier portions of the anulus 10 or endplates. With the barrier-type anulus augmentation 12 in place, as embodied in various aspects of the present invention, nuclear augmentation materials 7 or devices can conform to healthy regions of the anulus 10 while the barrier 12 shields weaker regions of the anulus 10.
  • Figure 62 is a cross-sectional transverse view of an anulus barrier device 12 implanted within a disc 15 along the inner surface of a lamella 16. Implanted conformable nuclear augmentation 7 is also shown in contact with the barrier 12. The barrier device 12 is juxtapositioned to the innermost lamella of the anulus. Conformable nuclear augmentation material 7 is inserted into the cavity which is closed by the barrier 12, in an amount sufficient to fill the disc space in an unloaded supine position.
  • fluid nuclear augmentation 554 such as hyaluronic acid
  • Fluid nuclear augmentation 554 is particularly well-suited for use in various aspects of the current invention because it can be delivered with minimal invasiveness and because it is able to flow into and fill minute voids of the intervertebral disc space. Fluid nuclear augmentation 554 is also uniquely suited for maintaining a pressurized environment that evenly transfers the force exerted by the endplates to the anulus augmentation device and/or the anulus.
  • fluid nuclear augmentation materials 554 used alone may perform poorly in discs 15 with a degenerated anulus because the material can flow back out tlirough anulus defects 8 and pose a risk to surrounding structures.
  • Exemplary fluid nuclear augmentation materials 554 include, but are not limited to, various pharmaceuticals (steroids, antibiotics, tissue necrosis factor alpha or its antagonists, analgesics); growth factors, genes or gene vectors in solution; biologic materials (hyaluronic acid, non-crosslinked collagen, fibrin, liquid fat or oils); synthetic polymers (polyethylene glycol, liquid silicones, synthetic oils); and saline.
  • any one of these materials may be used alone or that a combination of two or more of these materials may be used together to form the nuclear augmentation material.
  • Any of a variety of additional additives such as thickening agents, carriers, polymerization initiators or inhibitors may also be included, depending upon the desired infusion and long-term performance characteristics, hi general, "fluid” is used herein to include any material which is sufficiently flowable at least during the infusion process, to be infused through an infusion lumen in the delivery device into the disc space.
  • the augmentation material 554 may remain "fluid” after the infusion step, or may polymerize, cure, or otherwise harden to a less flowable or nonflowable state.
  • nucleus augmentation material 554 may remain constant during the deployment and post-deployment stages or may change, from a first infusion state to a second, subsequent implanted state.
  • a carrier such as a solvent or fluid medium with a dispersion therein.
  • the solvent or liquid carrier may be absorbed by the body or otherwise dissipate from the disc space post-implantation, leaving the nucleus augmentation material 554 behind.
  • any of a variety of the powders identified below may be earned using a fluid carrier.
  • Figure 63 is a cross-sectional transverse view of anulus barrier device 12 implanted within a disc 15 along an inner surface of a lamella 16.
  • Implanted nuclear augmentation 7 comprised of a hydrophilic flexible solid is also shown.
  • Nuclear augmentation materials include, but are not limited to, liquids, gels, solids, gases or combinations thereof.
  • Nuclear augmentation devices 7 may be formed from one or more materials, which are present in one or more phases.
  • Figure 63 shows a cylindrical flexible solid form of nuclear augmentation 7.
  • this flexible solid is composed of a hydrogel, including, but not limited to, acrylonitrile, acrylic acid, polyacrylimide, acrylimide, acrylimidine, polyacrylonitrile, polyvinylalcohol, and the like.
  • Figure 63 depicts nuclear augmentation 7 using a solid or gel composition. If required, these materials can be designed to be secured to surrounding tissues by mechanical means, such as glues, screws, and anchors, or by biological means, such as glues and in growth.
  • Solid but deformable augmentation materials 7 may also be designed to resist axial compression by the endplates rather than flowing circumferentially outward toward the anulus. hi this way, less force is directed at the anulus 10.
  • Solid nuclear augmentation 7 can also be sized substantially larger than the annulotomy 416 or defect 8 to decrease the risk of extrusion.
  • the use of solid materials or devices 7 alone is subject to certain limitations. The delivery of solid materials 7 may require a large access hole 417 in the anulus 10, thereby decreasing the integrity of the disc 15 and creating a significant risk for extrusion of either the augmentation material 7 or of natural nucleus 20 remaining within the disc 15.
  • Solid materials or devices 7 can also overload the endplates causing endplate subsidence or apply point loads to the anulus 10 from comers or edges that may cause pain or further deterioration of the anulus 10.
  • Several embodiments of the present invention overcome the limitations of solid materials and are particularly well- suited for use with liquid augmentation materials 7.
  • the barrier device 12 of various embodiments of this invention effectively closes the access hole 417 and can be adapted to partially encapsulate the augmented nucleus, thus mitigating the risks posed by solid materials.
  • Solid or gel nuclear augmentation materials 7 used in various embodiments of the current invention include single piece or multiple pieces.
  • the solid materials 7 may be cube-like, spheroid, disc-like, ellipsoid, rhombohedral, cylindrical, or amorphous in shape. These materials 7 may be in woven or non-woven form. Other forms of solids including minute particles or even powder can be considered when used in combination with the barrier device.
  • Candidate materials 7 include, but are not limited to: metals, such as titanium, stainless steels, nitinol, cobalt chrome; resorbable or non- resorbing synthetic polymers, such as polyurethane, polyester, PEEK, PET, FEP, PTFE, ePTFE, Teflon, PMMA, nylon, carbon fiber, Delrin, polyvinyl alcohol gels, polyglycohc acid, polyethylene glycol; silicon gel or rabber, vulcanized rubber or other elastomer; gas filled vesicles, biologic materials such as morselized or block bone, hydroxy apetite, cross- linked collagen, muscle tissue, fat, cellulose, keratin, cartilage, protein polymers, transplanted or bioengineered nucleus pulposus or anulus fibrosus; or various pharmacologically active agents in solid form.
  • metals such as titanium, stainless steels, nitinol, cobalt chrome
  • synthetic polymers such as
  • the solid or gel augmentation materials 7 may be rigid, wholly or partially flexible, elastic or viscoelastic in nature.
  • the augmentation device or material 7 may be hydrophilic or hydrophobic. Hydrophilic materials, mimicking the physiology of the nucleus, may be delivered into the disc in a hydrated or dehydrated state. Biologic materials may be autologous, allograft, zenograft, or bioengineered.
  • the solid or gel nuclear augmentation material 7, as depicted in Figure 63 are impregnated or coated with various compounds.
  • a biologically active compound is used, hi one embodiment, one or more drag carriers are used to impregnate or coat the nuclear augmentation material 7.
  • Tissue in-growth either fibrous (from the anulus) or bony (from the endplates), within or around the augmentation material can be either encouraged or discouraged depending on the augmentation used.
  • Tissue in-growth may be beneficial for fixation and can be encouraged via porosity or surface chemistry.
  • Surface in-growth or other methods of fixation of the augmentation material 7 can be encouraged on a single surface or aspect so as to not interfere with the normal range of motion of the spinal unit, hi this way, the material is stabilized and safely contained within the anulus 10 without resulting in complete fixation which might cause fusion and prohibit disc function.
  • Figure 64 is a cross-sectional transverse view of anulus barrier device 12 implanted within a disc 15 along an inner surface of a lamella 16.
  • Several types of implanted nuclear augmentation 7, including a solid cube, a composite cylindrical solid 555, and a free flowing liquid 554 are shown.
  • the use of multiple types of nuclear augmentation with the barrier 12 is depicted in Figure 64.
  • the barrier device 12 is shown in combination with fluid nuclear augmentation 554, solid nuclear augmentation 7, in the form of a cube, and a cross-linked collagen sponge composite 555 soaked in a growth factor.
  • a multiphase augmentation system as shown in Figure 64, is used. A combination of solids and liquids is used in a preferred embodiment.
  • Nuclear augmentation 7 comprising solids and liquids 554 can be designed to create primary and secondary levels of flexibility within an intervertebral disc space, hi use, the spine will flex easily at first as the intervertebral disc pressure increases and the liquids flows radially, loading the anulus. Then, as the disc height decreases and the endplates begin to contact the solid or gelatinous augmentation material, flexibility will decrease. This combination can also prevent damage to the anulus 10 under excessive loading as the solid augmentation 7 can be designed to resist further compression such that the fluid pressure on the anulus is limited.
  • use of multiphase augmentation allows for the combination of fluid medications or biologically active substances with solid or gelatinous earners.
  • the nuclear augmentation material or device 7, 554 constracted therefrom is phase changing, e.g., from liquid to solid, solid to liquid, or liquid to gel.
  • phase changing augmentation preferably changes from a liquid to a solid or gel. Such materials may change phases in response to contact with air, increases or decreases in temperature, contact with biologic liquids or by the mixture of separate reactive constituents.
  • the barrier device is used to seal and pressurize a phase changing material to aid in its delivery by forcing it into the voids of the disc space while minimizing the risk of extrusion of the material while it is a fluid, hi this situation, the barrier or anulus augmentation device 12 may be permanently implanted or used only temporarily until the desired phase change has occurred.
  • an anulus augmentation device 12 that exploits the characteristics of nucleus augmentation devices or materials to improve its own performance is provided.
  • Augmenting the nucleus 20 pressurizes the intervertebral disc environment which can serve to fix or stabilize an anulus repair device in place.
  • the nucleus 20 can be pressurized by inserting into the disc 15 an adequate amount of augmentation material 1, 554.
  • the pressurized disc tissue and augmentation material 7, 554 applies force on the inwardly facing surface of the anulus augmentation device 12.
  • This pressure may be exploited by the design of the anulus prosthesis or barrier 12 to prevent it from dislodging or moving from its intended position.
  • One exemplary method is to design the inwardly facing surface of the anulus prosthesis 12 to expand upon the application of pressure. As the anulus prosthesis 12 expands, it becomes less likely to be expelled from the disc.
  • the prosthesis 12 may be formed with a concavity facing inward to promote such expansion.
  • the anulus augmentation device 12 itself functions as nuclear augmentation 7.
  • the barrier 12 frame is encapsulated in ePTFE. This construct typically displaces a volume of 0.6 cubic centimeters, although thicker coatings of ePTFE or like materials may be used to increase this volume to 3 cubic centimeters.
  • the anulus augmentation device may be designed with differentially thickened regions along its area.
  • Figure 65 depicts a sagittal cross-sectional view of the barrier device connected to an inflatable nuclear augmentation device 455.
  • the barrier device 12 is shown connected via hollow delivery and support tube 425 to an nuclear augmentation sack 455 suitable for containing fluid material 554.
  • the tube 425 has a delivery port or valve 450 that extends through the barrier device and can be accessed from the access hole 417 after the barrier device 12 and augmentation sack 455 has been delivered.
  • This nuclear and anulus augmentation combination is particularly advantageous because of the ease of deliverability, since the sack 455 and the barrier 12 are readily compressed.
  • the connection of the barrier 12 and the augmentation sack 455 also serves to stabilize the combination and prevent its extrusion from the disc 15.
  • the nuclear augmentation 7 may be secured to the anulus augmentation prosthesis 12 to create a resistance to migration of the overall construct.
  • Such attachment may also be performed to improve or direct the transfer of load from the nuclear prosthesis 7 tlirough the anulus prosthesis 12 to the disc tissues.
  • the barrier 12 and augmentation 7 can be attached prior to, during, or after delivery of the barrier 12 into the disc 15. They may be secured to each other by an adhesive or by a flexible filament such as suture.
  • the barrier 12 may have a surface facing the augmentation material 7 that bonds to the augmentation material 7 though a chemical reaction. This surface may additionally allow for a mechanical linkage to a surface of the augmentation material 7. This linkage could be achieved through a porous attachment surface of the barrier 12 that allows the inflow of a fluid augmentation material 7 that hardens or gels after implantation.
  • the anulus augmentation device 12 and nuclear augmentation material 7 may be fabricated as a single device with a barrier 12 region and a nuclear augmentation region 7.
  • the barrier 12 may form at least a portion of the surface of an augmentation sack 455 or balloon.
  • the sack 455 may be filled with suitable augmentation materials 7 once the barrier has been positioned along a weakened inner surface of the anulus 10.
  • the sequence of inserting the barrier 12 and nuclear augmentation 7 in the disc can be varied according to the nuclear augmentation 7 used or requirements of the surgical procedure.
  • the nuclear augmentation 7 can be inserted first and then sealed in place by the barrier device 12.
  • the disc 15 can be partially filled, then sealed with the barrier device 12, and then supplied with additional material 7.
  • the barrier device 12 is inserted into the disc 15 followed by the addition of nuclear augmentation material 7 through or around the barrier 12. This allows for active pressurization. A disc 15 with a severely degenerated anulus can also be effectively treated in this manner.
  • the nuclear augmentation material 7 is delivered through a cannula inserted through an access hole 417 in the disc 15 formed pathologically, e.g. an anular defect 8, or iatrogenically, e.g. an anuulotomy 416 that is distinct from the access hole 417 that was used to implant the barrier 12.
  • Access hole 417 can be located anywhere along the anulus surface or even through the vertebral endplates.
  • the anulus augmentation device 12 includes features that facilitate the introduction of augmentation materials 554 following placement.
  • the augmentation delivery cannula may simply be forcibly driven into an access hole 417 proximal to the barrier 12 at a slight angle so that the edge of the barrier 12 defo ⁇ ns and allows passage into the disc space.
  • a small, flexible or rigid curved delivery needle or tube may be inserted through an access hole 417 over (in the direction of the superior endplate) or under (in the direction of the inferior endplate) the barrier 12 or around an edge of the barrier 12 contiguous with the anulus 15.
  • ports or valves are installed in the banier 12 device that permit the flow of augmentation material into, but not out of, the disc space.
  • One-way valves 450 or even flaps of material held shut by the intervertebral pressure may be used.
  • a collapsible tubular valve may be fashioned along a length of the banier.
  • multiple valves or ports 450 are present along the device 12 to facilitate alignment with the access hole 417 and delivery of augmentation material.
  • FIG. 66 is sagittal cross-sectional view of a functional spine unit containing the barrier device unit 12 connected to a wedge-shaped nuclear augmentation 7 device.
  • Figure 66 illustrates that the geometry of the nuclear augmentation 7 can be adapted to improve the function of the banier.
  • nuclear augmentation 7 By presenting nuclear augmentation 7 with a wedge-shaped or hemicircular profile towards the interior of the intervertebral disc space, and attaching it in the middle of the barrier device 12 between the flexible finger- like edges of the barrier device, the force exerted by the pressurized environment is focused in the direction of the edges of the barrier device sealing them against the endplates. Accordingly, this wedge-shaped feature improves the function of the device 12.
  • the nuclear augmentation material 7 may also be designed with various features that improve its interaction with the banier, such as exhibiting different flexibility or viscosity throughout its volume.
  • the augmentation 7 may be either stiff at the interface with the barrier 12 and supple towards the center of the disc, or vice versa.
  • the augmentation 7 can also serve to rotationally stabilize the barrier 12.
  • the augmentation is coupled to the inward facing surface of the banier and extends outward and medially into the disc forming a lever arm and appearing as "T-shaped" unit.
  • the augmentation device 7 of this embodiment can extend from the middle of the disc 15 to the opposite wall of the anulus.
  • the anulus augmentation device comprises a mesh.
  • Figure 67 shows one example of a meshed anulus augmentation device, hi one embodiment, a repair mesh that is resilient is provided, i some embodiments, the mesh is particularly advantageous because it can withstand millions of motion cycles within the disc environment, and is resistant to fatigue.
  • fatigue resistance is accomplished by material properties, structural design, or a combination thereof.
  • a fatigue resistant stracture can be designed to distribute the strain of deformation as evenly as possible over as much material as possible so as to minimize stress concentrations that could initiate fatigue cracks.
  • a coiled spring may deform millions of times without failure or cracking because the strain is distributed evenly over a length of metal.
  • an anulus repair mesh For an anulus repair mesh, the same effect maybe achieved by means such as, but not limited to, providing more material for a given deformation site by having mesh members curved throughout their lengths, alternating mesh curves in a sine- wave or zigzag pattern to provide more material and distributed strains, or having longer non linear members such that a given deformation results in less material strain, or pre- shaping the implant to minimize strain at the implantation site.
  • the curvilinear, nonlinear, coiled, or angled members can be interconnected, woven, networked, or emanate from or be attached to rails or members to form a framework or define a mesh or barrier.
  • a mesh can be used in a variety of locations in and around the intervertebral disc.
  • the mesh can be placed on an external surface of the anulus, along an endplate, within the anulus, between the anulus and nucleus, within the nucleus, or within both the anulus and nucleus.
  • the mesh can be held in place via counteracting forces of the mesh as it flexes from its unstressed shape to stressed shape or friction with disc tissue, between disc and vertebral body tissue or between disc augmentation material or another implant and disc tissue.
  • the mesh can also have a porosity or macrotexture including ridges, spikes or spirals to increase bioincorporation and fixation.
  • Fixation devices including but not limited to, sutures, glue, screws, and staples can be used to permanently fix the mesh in place.
  • the anulus augmentation device is a banier comprising a membrane and a frame.
  • the frame is the mesh, hi other embodiment, the mesh is coated with the membrane, hi another embodiment, the anulus augmentation device comprises only a frame.
  • the mesh or frame region of the implant can preferably be fonned from a relatively thin sheet of material.
  • the material may be a polymer(including in-situ polymerizing), metal, or gel.
  • NITINOL nickel titanium alloy
  • nylon polyvinyl alcohol, polyethylene, polyurethane, polypropylene, polycaprolactone, polyacrylate, ethylene-vinyl acetates, polystyrene, polyvinyl oxide, polyvinyl fluoride, polyvinyl imidazole, chlorosulphonated polyolefms, polyethylene oxide, polytetrafluoroethylene and nylon, and copolymers and combinations thereof, polycarbonate, Kevlar TM, acetal, cobalt chrome, carbon, graphite, metal matrix composites, stainless steel and other metals, alloys and composites. Some materials may be coated to achieve biocompatibility.
  • the mesh or frame designs may have sharp edges or have gaps that may allow for tissue transfer outside of the disc.
  • a membrane may be secured to one or more sides or portions of the mesh or frame in order to resist transfer of particles across its periphery and outside of the disc or to shield the body from the mesh's sharp edges.
  • a membrane can prevent the flow of a material bounded by the anulus fibrosis of the intervertebral disc through a defect in the anulus fibrosis if the device is positioned across the defect.
  • the size of the mesh device is dictated by the particular region of the functional spinal unit sought to be treated.
  • a mesh intended for coverage the interior surface of the posterior lateral anulus can be about 2 cm to about 4 cm in length and about 2 mm to about 15 mm in height.
  • the mesh can be sized to cover the entire exterior or interior surface of a disc.
  • the size of the mesh can be selected to adequately span it in more than one direction.
  • the mesh is sized such that it spans all directions by at least about 2 mm. The overlap provided by the about 2 mm or more mesh, in some embodiments, provides mechanical means by which the mesh resists extrusion through a defect.
  • the surgeon can select a mesh, barrier, or patch that is sized such that even if the barrier shifts along an axis in either direction, the selected width ensures that there remains about 2 mm or more of the device beyond the edge of the defect in all positions along that portion of the anulus. hi this way a surgeon can determine a minimum implant size that will still be efficacious.
  • the anulus augmentation device such as a mesh or a membrane/frame combination, has a thiclcness in a range between about 0.025 mm to about 3 mm. Nucleus pulposus particles have been measured at around 0.8 mm 2 .
  • the anulus augmentation device such as a mesh or a membrane/frame combination
  • the anulus augmentation device has pores slightly smaller (e.g., about 0.05 mm 2 to about 0.75 mm 2 ) and still function as a means to prevent extrusion of nuclear material from the disc.
  • the size of disc particles sought to be contained by the mesh can be determined.
  • Such a design affords the fluid transfer of other smaller particles and especially water, blood, and other tissue fluids.
  • the cross-section of the mesh can be flat, concave, convex or hinged (or flexibly connected) along at least a portion of one or more horizontal axes or vertical axes.
  • an implant having a volume of about 0.2 to about 2.0 cc is provided.
  • the implant can include an anulus augmentation device, a nuclear augmentation device or an anulus augmentation/nuclear augmentation combination device.
  • a device having an overall volume of about 0.5 cc is provided because this is the most typical volume removed. Also, greater volumes may be used to further increase the volume of the disc in cases where disc height has decreased over time and the fragments have been metabolized (and thus do not require removal).
  • an implant comprising a frame and a membrane is provided. In other embodiments, the implant comprises only one or more membranes. In one embodiment, the implant comprises only one or more frames. The frame may be coated.
  • the membrane (or coating) can be comprised of any suitably durable and flexible material including polymers, elastomers, hydrogels and gels such as polyvinyl alcohol, polyethylene, polyurethane, polypropylene, polycaprolactone, polyacrylate, ethylene-vinyl acetates, polystyrene, polyvinyl oxides, polyvinyl fluorides, polyvinyl imidazole, chlorosulphonated polyolefin, polyethylene oxide, polytetrafluoroethylene, a nylon, silicone, rabber, polylactide, polyglycohc acid, polylactide-co-glycolide, polycaprolactone, polycarbonate, polyamide, polyanhydride, polyamino acid, polyortho ester, polyacetal, polycyanoacrylate, degradable polyurethane, copolymers and derivatives and combinations thereof.
  • polymers, elastomers, hydrogels and gels such as polyvinyl alcohol, polyethylene
  • Biological materials including keratin, albumin collagen, elastin, prolamines, engineered protein polymers, and derivatives and combinations thereof, may also be used.
  • at least a portion of the anulus augmentation device e.g., the membrane, mesh, barrier, etc, can be impregnated with, coated with, or designed to carry and deliver diagnostic agents and/or therapeutic agents. Diagnostic agents include, but are not limited to, radio-opaque materials suitable to permit imaging by MRI or X-ray.
  • Therapeutic agents include, but are not limited to, steroids, genetic vectors, antibodies, antiseptics, growth factors such as somatomedins, insulin-like growth factors, fibroblast growth factors, bone morphogenic growth factors, endothelial growth factors, transforming growth factors, platelet derived growth factors, hepatocytic growth factors, keratinocyte growth factors, angiogenic factors, immune system suppressors, antibiotics, living cells such as fibroblasts, chondrocytes, chondroblasts, osteocytes, mesenchymal cells, epithelial cells, and endothelial cells, and cell-binding proteins and peptides.
  • growth factors such as somatomedins, insulin-like growth factors, fibroblast growth factors, bone morphogenic growth factors, endothelial growth factors, transforming growth factors, platelet derived growth factors, hepatocytic growth factors, keratinocyte growth factors, angiogenic factors, immune system suppressors, antibiotics, living cells
  • the nuclear augmentation device can be impregnated, coated, or designed to cany diagnostic and/or therapeutic agents.
  • a mesh having a series of curvilinear elements 602 is provided, hi one embodiment, the curvilinear elements 602 are interconnected.
  • the interconnections 602 can be distributed to form one or more contiguous horizontal bands, rails, members, struts, or axes 604.
  • Figure 67 shows such a device with a central horizontal axis 604 and "S" shaped curvilinear elements 602.
  • the "S" shaped elements 602 tend to distribute the stress generated under compression over a larger area, hi one embodiment, only portions of the "S" move out of plane during loading providing stiffness.
  • the curvilinear elements are particularly advantageous because they provide flexibility, resilience and/or rigidity.
  • the curvilinear elements 602 can be oriented about 90 degrees (curving in the ventral/dorsal axis) such that the curves appear in the overall horizontal cross-section of the implant, hi other embodiments, the curvilinear elements 602 are substantially flat.
  • the curvilinear elements 602 can also be oriented at any angle (e.g., from about 1 degree to about 179 degrees) from the plane.
  • the mesh 600 can be straight, convex or concave in cross-section.
  • Figures 68A-G show the profile of a mesh with various curvilinear elements.
  • Figures 68D-G show top cross-sectional views of the mesh being elongated "U” shaped, "C” shaped, curvilinear shaped (like a- typical posterior anulus interior surface), and "D" shaped to extend along and cover the entire inner anulus surface, or portions thereof.
  • Figure 69 shows yet another embodiment of a mesh 600 implanted in an intervertebral disc.
  • the curvilinear elements 602 comprise springs, coils, or telescopic members that are adapted to compress axially (like pneumatic pistons or coil springs) under loading rather than bending and confonning to a tissue surface, e.g. the inner surface of the anulus.
  • a spring or coil-type mesh is that the mesh can be fairly rigid and resistant to lateral or transverse force but is flexible enough to span around the curvatures of the disc while maintaining contact with the endplates under compression and expansion.
  • the springs or coils can be interconnected, linked in a loose or hinge-like arrangement, attached to a horizontal band or axis, attached to a membrane, or encapsulated within a membrane.
  • the mesh may also be configured (e.g., from wire or stock) in a pattern comprising a series of repeating curved peaks and valleys oriented in a lateral manner. Two or more curved wires may be superimposed out of phase such that one peak is inferior to the adjacent wires valley.
  • the two wires can be independent, contiguous and formed from a single wire, connected at one or more points, attached to a membrane, or encapsulated within a membrane.
  • Figure 70 shows a wire-type anulus augmentation device.
  • an annulus augmentation device can comprise, for example, a frame, a membrane or a frame/membrane combination.
  • Figure 70 shows just the frame, which can be, for example, a wire or mesh-like device.
  • Figures 71A-E show a mesh that has been encapsulated by a membrane or cover to produce an encapsulated mesh 606.
  • Figures 71 C shows a top view cross-section wherein the mesh is elongated U shaped and 7 ID tlirough 7 IF show various side view cross-sections wherein the mesh is straight or possesses varying degrees of concavity.
  • the membrane or encapsulation material may be of substantial thickness or may be substantially thin. Indeed, the encapsulation material may simply be a coating.
  • a mesh 600 having a double-wishbone frame with or without membrane cover is provided, hi some embodiments, this design is particularly advantageous because it reduces the compression and stress experienced by the implant under flexion, extension, and lateral bending.
  • Figure 72A shows the frame without a membrane situated along a posterior portion of the disc.
  • the implant e.g., the frame
  • the implant can also be placed on the outside of the anulus, within the anulus, between the nucleus and anulus or within the nucleus.
  • Figure 72B shows the mesh in a perspective view outside of the disc.
  • the frame (e.g., mesh) can be flat or an elongated "U" shaped conesponding to the inner surface of the posterior anulus.
  • the frame can be a single continuous band or wire forming two ends, a first end and a second end.
  • each end functions as a living hinge and forms an apex which may be in the form of a curve, a bend, or series of bends such that the wire is generally redirected in the opposite direction. Accordingly, if a load is applied along the vertical axis at the midpoint of the frame, e.g., the midpoint of the top and bottom (superior, inferior) rail, each comer or apex is loaded equally and the wire rails act as levers.
  • the mesh 600 can be implanted such that the midpoint of the mesh frame 600 is in the posterior of the disc and the ends reside medially or even in the anterior portion of the disc, hi this way the portion of the mesh 600 that undergoes the greatest compression is furthest away from each end. Accordingly, a relatively large range of motion can be traversed by the middle of the device but this will only translate to limited motion at each end or living hinge, thus reducing stress and fatigue. Also, by placing each end (which has a relatively small profile) at opposing sides at the midline of the disc (the center of rotation) it is subjected to almost no direct loading under lateral bending, flexion, extension, or compression by the endplates.
  • Figures 73A-C shows other embodiments for the end or natural hinge portion of the frame (e.g., mesh 600) , including a loop formation.
  • Figures 74A-C show some embodiments of the central band or strut 604.
  • Figures 74A-B show a central reinforcement band 604 disposed between the ends or apexes of the frame (e.g., mesh).
  • the central band 604 can be positioned between the top rail (or wire) 603 and bottom rail (or wire) 605.
  • the central band 604 can be elongated to form a concave cross-section between the top and bottom rail or wire.
  • an implant e.g., an anulus augmentation device, such as a mesh
  • an implant can exhibit different mechanical properties along various axes.
  • an implant can exhibit rigidity along a first axis and flexibility (or less rigidity) along a second axis transverse or perpendicular to the first.
  • Such an implant might find particular utility along the wall of an anulus between two adjacent vertebrae because such an environment will subject the implant to vertical compression (e.g., along the superior/inferior axis) yet will not compress the implant laterally.
  • the implant can retain its rigidity along its horizontal axis.
  • Rigidity along the horizontal axis of anulus augmentation device is especially useful in some embodiments if the implant is placed in front of a weakened or defective surface of the anulus because a point load will like form at that region when the disc is compressed under loading and could cause the implant to bend and extrude. Accordingly, an implant having a certain degree of rigidity along its lateral axis resists such bending and extrusion. Moreover, because of the less rigid and more flexible behavior of the implant along its vertical axis loads caused flexion and extension of the spine will allow the implant to flex naturally with the spine and not injure the endplates. [0286] hi some embodiments, to achieve the differences in mechanical properties, any number of construction, material selection or fabrication techniques known in the art can be used.
  • the implant may be made thicker or thinner at points along a particular axis or voids or patterns may be cut into the material.
  • a composite implant having different material sandwiched together can also be used. Struts, members, rails and the like may be added to, secured to, or integral to the implant to provide stiffness and rigidity. Further, such stiffening elements can be added during the implantation procedure.
  • the implant can also be corrugated along an axis or otherwise be provided with bents or curves to provide stiffness.
  • a gentle curve or "C" shaped cross-section that could also conform or correspond to the imier curved surface of an anulus is also preferable for making a seal with the anulus and for resisting bending along the implant horizontal axis e.g., the curve would resist flattening out, flexing or bending laterally.
  • the implant can be oversized such that it remains in compression along one or more of its axes in its implanted state such that even under flexion and extension of the spine the corrugations or curved sections never flatten out and thus retain rigidity (or less flexibility) along an axis perpendicular to the curves.
  • the implant e.g., an anulus augmentation device, such as a mesh
  • the implant can be more or less rigid or flexible, according to the preference of the practitioner or disc environment.
  • the degree of desired rigidity and flexibility along each axis can be determined based on factors such as defect size, intervertebral pressure, implant deliverability, desired degree of compression and disc height.
  • an implant has a "C" cross-section, a central rail and top and bottom rails, and curvilinear elements comiect the rails.
  • the frame or mesh can be comprised of any of the suitable materials discussed herein, (e.g.
  • the implant is more rigid along its lateral axis because of its "C" cross-section or the rails and less rigid along its vertical axis because of the void caused by the pattern and lack of corrugations or stiffening elements.
  • some embodiments of the invention disclose a mesh frame, patch, plate, biocompatible support member or barrier adapted to extend along the imier circumference of an anulus fibrosus, other embodiments contemplate partial coverage of the anulus or tissue surface.
  • one or more projections extending outward from, or off-angle to the implant can be configured to resist migration or movement of the implant within the disc under cyclical loading and movement of the spine.
  • One advantage of such embodiments is that they can reduce or prevent migration. Undesired migration may render the implant ineffective or cause it to pathologically interfere with adjacent tissue including the anulus, nucleus, endplates and spinal cord.
  • an implant can be stabilized within an intervertebral disc by providing a support member or patch with an off-angle projection functioning as a lever arm or keel.
  • an anulus augmentation device can have one or more comers, sides or projections connected at the opposing end of the devices midsection or middle portion.
  • Such a configuration is especially effective when implanted into an intervertebral disc such that the midsection of the barrier is inserted along the posterior anulus and the comers and side projections are inserted along the posterio- lateral corners and lateral anulus respectively, hi one embodiment, the comer sections extend away from the posterior anulus toward the anterior of the disc.
  • the projections that project away from the posterior anulus at an angle are substantially parallel with or adjacent to the lateral anulus.
  • the projection portion of the implant in its implanted orientation is at once off-angle to the posterior anulus or midsection of the barrier and parallel to the lateral anulus.
  • the anulus defines a bounded area such a projection may indeed collide with or be parallel with another adjacent or opposing surface of the anulus but still function to stabilize the device along the other surface.
  • the device can also be designed with one or more projections that are angled toward the medial, anterior, posterior, or lateral portion of the disc such that the projection contacts mostly or exclusively nucleus tissue or endplate.
  • a looped projection connected at the top and bottom and/or opposing ends of the support member, frame, or patch can be configured to extend across the disc from about 3 mm to about 30 mm and only contact nucleus tissue, hi another embodiment, one or more projections can be oriented into a defect in the anulus and occupy less than or all of its volume, hi another embodiment, a projection situated within a defect may be anchored into an endplate adjacent the defect.
  • Figures 75A-L show an implant 610 (e.g., an annulus augmentation device such as a mesh) having one or more projections extending into the disc or into a defect.
  • a stabilizing projection according to one or more embodiments of the invention can be integral or affixed to the surgical mesh, patch, plate, biocompatible support member or banier device.
  • the stabilizing projection can also be independent of or coupled to at least a portion of the frame or the membrane.
  • the stabilizing projection can be constructed from the same material as the frame or the membrane, or it can be constracted from different material.
  • the stabilizing projection can extend from any point or points along the device or device frame including its opposing ends, mid-section, along the top edge or along the bottom edge.
  • the projection can also form a loop in one or more planes including parallel and pe ⁇ endicular to the face of the device.
  • opposing end projections are connected to, or are integral to, the barrier and extend out from the barrier at an angle from about 0 to about 160 degrees
  • the projections are joined or are simply contiguous and form a bow-shaped or curved projection extending away from the banier.
  • the banier can be placed along a portion of the anulus and the bow would extend medially into the disc.
  • the barrier can be placed along at least a portion of the posterior anulus and the bowed projection, attached at the opposing ends of the barrier frame or membrane, would extend toward the anterior of the disc.
  • Figure 76 shows an implant 610 according to one embodiment of the invention.
  • a bow-like anterior projection 612 extends outwardly from a posterior support member 614 (e.g., a patch, banier or mesh).
  • the projection 612 can be comiected at each end of the posterior support member 614 along its horizontal axis.
  • the projection 612 can be attached at any point along the vertical axis of the end including its midline, ends, or its entirety.
  • the projection 612 may be integral to the posterior support member 614 such that the posterior support member 614 is simply formed as a band or attached separately.
  • the implant 610 can be shaped like a bow.
  • the bow can be a gentle arc, curved, re-curved one or more times, triangular, rectangular, octagonal, linked multiple sided, oval or circular.
  • an arc or smooth bow may be advantageous for transfening loads evenly
  • a rigid mid-section portion or a comparatively flexible hinge-like mid-section along the bow is also presented.
  • the mid-section of the bow projection can have a different height than the remainder of the bow and be the same or different (less than or greater than) height than the midsection patch or biocompatible support member portion of the device.
  • Various embodiments of the bow or arcurate member or projection 612 can act like a spring to aid in holding the ends of the patch open and against the anulus wall.
  • the profile of the projection 612 can provide resistance to anterior travel of the implant through the nucleus or through the opposite wall of the anulus.
  • the projection or stabilizer 612 can also provide torsional resistance to the barrier 614.
  • the projection or bow 612 extends across the endplates it creates an elongated profile functioning as a lever arm and thus resists rotation along the anulus wall within the disc.
  • the projection, bow or band portion 612 of the implant 610 can be tubular, wire-like, flat, mesh-like, curvilinear, bent, comprised of one or more rails, or contain voids.
  • the bow can define concavities facing inward or outward and be opposite or the same as the concavities defined by the biocompatible support member portion 614 of the implant 610.
  • the projection 612 can simply be angled projections of the biocompatible support member and be made of the same material and have the same properties. Alternatively the projection can have different properties such as less flexibility or more rigidity along one or more axes. Although one projection is shown in Figure 76, more than one bow-like projections may be used. [0296] Different bow or loop projection profiles may be useful for retaining nucleus tissue within the area bounded by the implant, soft anchoring to the nucleus or at least resisting travel through or along the nucleus, or for mechanically displacing nucleus tissue. Mechanical displacement (tlirough pinching or pressing) of the nucleus can increase disc height and serve to more uniformly load the anulus and improve the perfonnance of the implant.
  • the gap within the disc created by the bow or projection can be left vacant or filled in with suitable nucleus augmentation either tlirough, or around a periphery of the implant.
  • the bow projection 612 can also act as a piston or shock absorber that deforms under compressive loading of the disc relieving some of the load on the anulus caused by the nucleus being compressed between the endplates.
  • the stabilizing projection 612 can be made of the same material as the biocompatible support member 614 (e.g., barrier, patch or mesh).
  • the stabilizing projection 612 is an off-angle projection of the biocompatible support member 614 and forms a continuous loop or band
  • the stabilizing projection 612 can be made of a different biocompatible material, including polymers, metals, bio-materials, and grafts.
  • Figures 77A-H show various cross-sectional side views of an implant 610 along a horizontal axis according to one or more embodiments of the invention. Accordingly, a bow, band or projection can be uniform in height or non-uniform. It can be the same height, shorter or taller than the patch portion of the implant.
  • a projection is narrow at the point where it connects to the posterior support member component of the implant and then flairs near the midline of the anterior bow until its height exceeds the posterior member height.
  • a projection can have different mechanical properties than the support member or patch section of the implant.
  • a projection is more or less flexible along one or more axes compared to the patch or biocompatible support member portion of the implant.
  • a projection can be concave along one or more axes, or can have variable regions of concavity along the same axis.
  • Figures 78A-J show various cross-sectional top views of implants 610 along a vertical axis according to some embodiments of the invention.
  • Figure 78G shows an implant (e.g., an anulus augmentation device such as a mesh) that has a puckered bow-like projection that is well-suited for disc mo ⁇ hology.
  • Figures 79A-F show a frontal view of a portion of various embodiments of projections according to one or more embodiments of the invention.
  • Figures 80A-D show various cross-sections of projection 612, according to some embodiments of the invention.
  • Figures 81A-D show looped or bent bow-type projections 612 that are contiguous or integral with, or are connected to the biocompatible support member 614 at two or more points along a vertical or horizontal axis.
  • Figure 81 A shows a criss-cross loop projection.
  • Figure 81B shows a strap-like projection.
  • Figure 81C shows a projection that is integral with the support member such that the implant forms a circular band that serves to stabilize the device.
  • Figure 8 ID shows a box-frame type projection.

Abstract

Resilient surgical meshes that, in some aspects, can be compressed or otherwise configured, for minimally invasive delivery in the intervertebral discs are provided. According to one or more embodiments, the surgical mesh can be robust, fatigue resistant, stable and capable of withstanding the dynamic environment generic to intervertebral discs.

Description

STABILIZED INTERVERTEBRAL DISC BARRIER Background of the Invention Field of the Invention [0001] The present invention relates generally to the surgical treatment of intervertebral discs in the lumbar, cervical, or thoracic spine that have suffered from tears in the anulus fibrosis, herniation of the nucleus pulposus and/or significant disc height loss. Description of the Related Art [0002] The disc performs the important role of absorbing mechanical loads while allowing for constrained flexibility of the spine. The disc is composed of a soft, central nucleus pulposus (NP) surrounded by a tough, woven anulus fibrosis (AF). Herniation is a result of a weakening in the AF. Symptomatic herniations occur when weakness in the AF allows the NP to bulge or leak posteriorly toward the spinal cord and major nerve roots. The most common resulting symptoms are pain radiating along a compressed nerve and low back pain, both of which can be crippling for the patient. The significance of this problem is increased by the low average age of diagnosis, with over 80% of patients in the U.S. being under 59. [0003] Since its original description by Mixter & Barr in 1934, discectomy has been the most common surgical procedure for treating intervertebral disc herniation. This procedure involves removal of disc materials impinging on the nerve roots or spinal cord external to the disc, generally posteriorly. Depending on the surgeon's preference, varying amounts of NP are then removed from within the disc space either through the herniation site or tlirough an incision in the AF. This removal of extra NP is commonly done to minimize the risk of recurrent herniation. [0004] Nevertheless, the most significant drawbacks of discectomy are recurrence of herniation, recurrence of radicular symptoms, and increasing low back pain. Re-herniation can occur in up to 21% of cases. The site for re-herniation is most commonly the same level and side as the previous herniation and can occur through the same weakened site in the AF. Persistence or recurrence of radicular symptoms happens in many patients and when not related to re-herniation, tends to be linked to stenosis of the neural foramina caused by a loss in height of the operated disc. Debilitating low back pain occurs in roughly 14% of patients. All of these failings are most directly related to the loss of NP material and AF competence that results from herniation and surgery. [0005] Various implants, surgical meshes, patches, barriers, tissue scaffolds and the like may be used to treat intervertebral discs and are known in the art. Surgical repair meshes are used throughout the body to treat and repair damaged tissue structures such as intralinguinal hernias, hemiated discs and to close iatrogenic holes and incisions as may occur elsewhere. Certain physiological environments present challenges to precise and minimally invasive delivery. [0006] An intervertebral disc provides a dynamic environment that produces high loads and pressures. Typically implants designed for this environment must be capable of enduring such conditions for long periods of time. Also, the difficulty and danger of the implantation procedure itself, due to the proximity of the spinal cord, limits the size and ease of placement of the implant. One or more further embodiments of the invention addresses the need for a durable fatigue resistant repair mesh capable of withstanding the dynamic environment generic to intervertebral discs. Summary of the Invention [0007] Several embodiments of the present invention relate generally to anulus augmentation devices, including, but not limited to, surgical meshes, barriers, and patches for treatment or augmentation of tissues within pathologic spinal discs. One or more embodiments comprise resilient surgical meshes that may be compressed for minimally invasive delivery and which are robust, stable, and resist fatigue and stress. These meshes are particularly well suited for intervertebral disc applications because they are durable enough to withstand intense cyclical loading and resist expulsion through a defect while not degrading over time. [0008] Several embodiments of the present invention seek to exploit the individual characteristics of various anulus and nuclear augmentation devices to optimize the performance of both within the intervertebral disc. Accordingly, one or more of the embodiments of the present invention provide minimally invasive and removable devices for closing a defect in an anulus and augmenting the nucleus. These devices may be permanent, semi-permanent, or removable. One function of anulus augmentation devices is to prevent or minimize the extrusion of materials from within the space normally occupied by the nucleus pulposus and inner anulus fibrosus. One function of nuclear augmentation devices is to at least temporarily add material to restore diminished disc height and pressure. Nuclear augmentation devices can also induce the growth or formation of material within the nuclear space. Accordingly, the inventive combination of these devices can create a synergistic effect wherein the anulus and nuclear augmentation devices serve to restore biomechanical function in a more natural biomimetic way. Furthermore, in one embodiment, both devices may be delivered more easily and less invasively. Also, in some embodiments, the pressurized environment made possible tlirough the addition of nuclear augmentation material and closing of the anulus serves both to restrain the nuclear augmentation and anchor the anulus augmentation in place.' [0009] As used herein, the phrase "anulus augmentation device" shall be given its ordinary meaning and shall also include devices that at least partially cover, close or seal a defect in an intervertebral disc, including, for example, barriers, meshes, patches, membranes, sealing means or closure devices. Thus, in one sense, the anulus augmentation device augments the anulus by sealing a defect in the anulus. hi some embodiments, one or more barriers, meshes, patches, membranes, sealing means or closure devices comprise a support member or frame. Thus, in one embodiment, a barrier that comprises a membrane and a frame is provided. As used herein, the terms augmenting or reinforcing (and variations thereto) shall be given their ordinary meaning and shall also mean supporting, covering, closing, patching, or sealing. [0010] hi one embodiment, one or more anulus augmentation devices are provided with one or more nuclear augmentation devices, hi some embodiments, the anulus barrier is integral with the nucleus augmentation, hi other embodiments, at least a portion of the barrier is separate from or independent of the nuclear augmentation. [0011] One or more of the embodiments of the present invention additionally provide an anulus augmentation device that is adapted for use with flowable nuclear augmentation material such that the flowable material cannot escape from the anulus after the anulus augmentation device has been implanted. [0012] h one embodiment of the present invention, a disc augmentation system configured to repair or rehabilitate an intervertebral disc is provided. The system comprises at least one anulus augmentation device, and at least one nuclear augmentation material. The anulus augmentation device prevents or minimizes the extrusion of materials from within the space normally occupied by the nucleus pulposus and inner anulus fibrosus. h one application of the invention, the anulus augmentation device is configured for minimally invasive implantation and deployment. The anulus augmentation device may either be a permanent implant, or it may removable. [0013] The nuclear augmentation material may restore diminished disc height and/or pressure. It may include factors for inducing the growth or formation of material within the nuclear space. It may either be permanent, removable, or absorbable. [0014] The nuclear augmentation material may be in the form of liquids, gels, solids, or gases, hi one embodiment, the nuclear augmentation material comprises materials selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: steroids, antibiotics, tissue necrosis factors, tissue necrosis factor antagonists, analgesics, growth factors, genes, gene vectors, hyaluronic acid, noncross-linked collagen, collagen, fibren, liquid fat, oils, synthetic polymers, polyethylene glycol, liquid silicones, synthetic oils, saline and hydrogel. The hydrogel may be selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: acrylonitriles, acrylic acids, polyacrylimides, acrylimides, acrylimidines, polyacrylnitriles, and polyvinyl alcohols. [0015] Solid form nuclear augmentation materials may be in the form of geometric shapes such as cubes, spheroids, disc-like components, ellipsoid, rhombohedral, cylindrical, or amorphous. The solid material may be in powder form, and may be selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: titanium, stainless steel, nitinol, cobalt, chrome, resorbable materials, polyurethane, polyesther, PEEK, PET, FEP, PTFE, ePTFE, PMMA, nylon, carbon fiber, Delrin, polyvinyl alcohol gels, polyglycolic acid, polyethylene glycol, silicone gel, silicone rubber, vulcanized rubber, gas-filled vesicles, bone, hydroxy apetite, collagen such as cross-linked collagen, muscle tissue, fat, cellulose, keratin, cartilage, protein polymers, transplanted nucleus pulposus, bioengineered nucleus pulposus, transplanted anulus fibrosis, and bioengineered anulus fibrosis. Structures may also be utilized, such as inflatable balloons or other inflatable containers, and spring-biased stmctures. [0016] The nuclear augmentation material may additionally comprise a biologically active compound. The compound may be selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: drug carriers, genetic vectors, genes, therapeutic agents, growth renewal agents, growth inhibitory agents, analgesics, anti-infectious agents, and anti-inflammatory drugs. [0017] h one embodiment, the anulus augmentation device comprises materials selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: steroids, antibiotics, tissue necrosis factors, tissue necrosis factor antagonists, analgesics, growth factors, genes, gene vectors, hyaluronic acid, noncross-linked collagen, collagen, fibren, liquid fat, oils, synthetic polymers, polyethylene glycol, liquid silicones, synthetic oils, saline, hydrogel (e.g., acrylonitriles, acrylic acids, polyacrylimides, acrylimides, acrylimidines, polyacrylnitriles, and polyvinyl alcohols), and other suitable materials. [0018] h some embodiments, the anulus augmentation device is constructed from one or more of the following materials: titanium, stainless steel, nitinol, cobalt, chrome, resorbable materials, polyurethane, polyesther, PEEK, PET, FEP, PTFE, ePTFE, PMMA, nylon, carbon fiber, Delrin, polyvinyl alcohol gels, polyglycohc acid, polyethylene glycol, silicone gel, silicone rubber, vulcanized rubber, gas-filled vesicles, bone, hydroxy apetite, collagen such as cross-linked collagen, muscle tissue, fat, cellulose, keratin, cartilage, and protein polymers. Transplanted anulus fibrosis and bioengineered anulus fibrosis may also be used to form the barrier, sealing device, closing device or membrane. Inflatable balloons or other inflatable containers, and spring-biased stmctures may also be used. [0019] The anulus augmentation device may comprise a biologically active compound. The compound may be selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: drug carriers, genetic vectors, genes, therapeutic agents, growth renewal agents, growth inhibitory agents, analgesics, anti-infectious agents, and anti-inflammatory drags, hi some embodiments, the biologically active compound is coupled to the barrier, sealing device, closing device or membrane, hi some embodiments, the biologically active compound coats the barrier, sealing device, closing device or membrane. [0020] In one embodiment, an anulus augmentation device for reinforcing an intervertebral disc is provided, hi one embodiment, the anulus augmentation device comprises a mesh frame, wherein the mesh frame comprises a plurality of flexible curvilinear members. In one embodiment, the curvalinear elements are interconnected. The interconnected curvilinear members are adapted to provide flexibility and resilience to the mesh frame. In some embodiments, the curvilinear members form a horizontal member or central strut. In one embodiment, the curvilinear members are arranged in a parallel configuration. [0021] h one embodiment, the curvilinear members comprise a metal alloy such as steel, nickel titanium, cobalt chrome, or combinations thereof. [0022] In some embodiments, the curvilinear members are constructed of nylon, polyvinyl alcohol, polyethylene, polyurethane, polypropylene, polycaprolactone, polyacrylate, ethylene-vinyl acetate, polystyrene, polyvinyl oxide, polyvinyl fluoride, polyvinyl imidazoles, chlorosulphonated polyolefm, polyethylene oxide, polytetrafluoroethylene, acetal, poly(p-phenyleneterephtalamide) (Kevlar™), poly carbonate, carbon, graphite, or a combination thereof. [0023] hi one embodiment, a membrane encapsulates, covers or coats at least a portion of the mesh frame, hi some embodiments, the membrane is coupled to the frame. [0024] The membrane of some embodiments is constructed of polymers, elastomers, gels, elastin, albumin, collagen, fibrin, keratin, or a combination thereof, hi several embodiments, the membrane comprises antibodies, antiseptics, genetic vectors, bone morphogenic proteins, steroids, cortisones, growth factors, or a combination thereof. The membrane may be a coating material. [0025] In one embodiment, the mesh frame is concave along at least a portion of at least one axis of said mesh frame. In one embodiment, the mesh frame has a length in the range of about 0.5 cm to about 5 cm. One of skill in the art will understand that other lengths can also be used, h some embodiments, the mesh frame is sized to cover at least a portion of an interior surface of an anulus lamella, hi other embodiments, the mesh frame is adapted to extend circumferentially along the entire surface of an anulus lamella. [0026] hi one embodiment, an anulus augmentation device comprising at least one projection that radiates from a mesh frame is provided. In one embodiment, the mesh frame has a vertical cross-section that is flat, concave, convex, or curvilinear. The horizontal cross-section can be concave, convex, flat, or kidney bean shaped. Other shapes can also be used. [0027] In one embodiment of the present invention, an anulus augmentation device for reinforcing an intervertebral disc comprises a mesh frame having a horizontal axis and a vertical axis, hi one embodiment, the mesh fame is concave along at least a portion the horizontal axis or the vertical axis, hi one embodiment, one or more projections radiate from the horizontal axis or the vertical axis of the mesh frame. The projections are adapted to stabilize the anulus augmentation device, hi one embodiment, a stabilizing projection has at least one dimension that is larger than the mesh frame, h other embodiments, the projection is smaller than the mesh frame. [0028] In yet another embodiment of the present invention, an intervertebral disc implant comprising a posterior support member having a first terminus and a second terminus is provided. In one embodiment, an anterior projection extends outwardly from the posterior support member. The anterior projection is attached to at least the first terminus or the second temiinus of the posterior support member. [0029] h another embodiments, an intervertebral disc implant comprising a posterior support member having a first temiinus and a second terminus and an anterior projection having a first end and a second end is provided. The anterior projection extends outwardly from the posterior support member. In one embodiment, the first end of the * anterior projection is coupled to the first terminus of the posterior support member; and the second end of the anterior projection is coupled to the second terminus of the posterior support member, thereby substantially forming a bow-shaped implant. The posterior support member and the anterior projection can be constructed of any suitable material, including but not limited to the materials described above for the mesh frame and the membrane. [0030] h a further embodiment of the present invention, a fatigue-resistant surgical mesh comprising rails is provided, hi one embodiment, the mesh comprises a top rail, a bottom rail coupled to the top rail, wherein the top rail and said bottom rail are coupled to each other at a first end and second end. In one embodiment, the top rail and the bottom rail extend to form a gap that is defined between the rails along at least a portion of the distance between the ends. [0031] hi one embodiment of the present invention, a spinal implant for treatment of an intervertebral disc is provided, hi one embodiment, a barrier or patch with a volume corresponding to the amount of material removed during a discectomy procedure is implanted, h one embodiment, the implant has a volume in a range of about 0.2 to about 2.0 cc. [0032] hi one embodiment of the invention, an intervertebral disc implant comprising a barrier forming a contiguous band is provided. In one embodiment, the band has variable heights or widths, hi one embodiment, the band has different degrees of flexibility along at least one axis. [0033] hi another embodiment of the present invention, a method of repairing or rehabilitating an intervertebral disc is provided. The method comprises inserting at least one anulus augmentation device into the disc, and inserting at least one nuclear augmentation material, to be held within the disc by the anulus augmentation device. The nuclear augmentation material may confomi to a first, healthy region of the anulus, while the anulus augmentation device conforms to a second, weaker region of the anulus. [0034] In a further embodiment, a method of repairing defective regions within a spinal disc is provided, hi one embodiment, the method comprises providing a surgical mesh, implanting the surgical mesh along an anulus surface, and positioning the surgical mesh at least such that about 2 mm of the device spans beyond at least one edge of the defective region of the disc. [0035] Further features and advantages of embodiments of the present invention will become apparent to those of skill in the art in view of the detailed description of preferred embodiments which follows, when taken together with the attached drawings and claims. Brief Description of the Drawings [0036] The foregoing and other objects, features and advantages of the invention will be apparent from the following more particular description of preferred embodiments of the invention, as illustrated in the accompanying drawings in which like reference characters refer to the same parts throughout the different views. The drawings are not necessarily to scale, emphasis instead being placed upon illustrating the principles of the invention. [0037] Figure 1 A shows a transverse section of a portion of a functional spine unit, in which part of a vertebra and intervertebral disc are depicted. [0038] Figure IB shows a sagittal cross section of a portion of a functional spine unit shown in Figure IA, in which two lumbar vertebrae and the intervertebral disc are visible. [0039] Figure IC shows partial disruption of the inner layers of an anulus fibrosis. [0040] Figure 2A shows a transverse section of one aspect of the present invention prior to supporting a hemiated segment, as shown in one embodiment. [0041] Figure 2B shows a transverse section of the construct in Fig. 2A supporting the hemiated segment. [0042] Figure 3A shows a transverse section of another embodiment of the disclosed invention after placement of the device. [0043] Figure 3B shows a transverse section of the construct in Fig. 3A after tension is applied to support the hemiated segment. [0044] Figure 4A shows a transverse view of an alternate embodiment of the invention. [0045] Figure 4B shows a sagittal view of the alternate embodiment shown in Figure 4A. [0046] Figure 5A shows a transverse view of another aspect of the present invention, as shown in one embodiment. [0047] Figure 5B shows the delivery tube of Figure 5 A being used to displace the hemiated segment to within its pre-herniated borders. [0048] Figure 5C shows a one-piece embodiment of the invention in an anchored and supporting position. [0049] Figure 6 shows one embodiment of the invention supporting a weakened posterior anulus fibrosis. [0050] Figure 7A shows a transverse section of another aspect of the disclosed invention demonstrating two stages involved in augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc. [0051] Figure 7B shows a sagittal view of the invention shown in Figure 7A. [0052] Figure 8 shows a transverse section of one aspect of the disclosed invention involving augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc and support/closure of the anulus fibrosis. [0053] Figure 9A shows a transverse section of one aspect of the invention involving augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc with the flexible augmentation material anchored to the anterior lateral anulus fibrosis. [0054] Figure 9B shows a transverse section of one aspect of the disclosed invention involving augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc with the flexible augmentation material anchored to the anulus fibrosis by a one-piece anchor. [0055] Figure 10A shows a transverse section of one aspect of the disclosed invention involving augmentation of the soft tissues of the disc. [0056] Figure 10B shows the construct of Figure 10A after the augmentation material has been inserted into the disc. [0057] Figure 11 illustrates a transverse section of a barrier mounted within an anulus. [0058] Figure 12 shows a sagittal view of the barrier of Figure 11. [0059] Figure 13 shows a transverse section of a barrier anchored within a disc. [0060] Figure 14 illustrates a sagittal view of the barrier shown in Figure 13. [0061] Figure 15 illustrates the use of a second anchoring device for a barrier mounted within a disc. [0062] Figure 16A is an transverse view of the intervertebral disc. [0063] Figure 16B is a sagittal section along the midline of the intervertebral disc. [0064] Figure 17 is an axial view of the intervertebral disc with the right half of a sealing means of a barrier means being placed against the interior aspect of a defect in anulus fibrosis by a dissection/delivery tool. [0065] Figure 18 illustrates a full sealing means placed on the interior aspect of a defect in anulus fibrosis. [0066] Figure 19 depicts the sealing means of Figure 18 being secured to tissues surrounding the defect. [0067] Figure 20 depicts the sealing means of Figure 19 after fixation means have been passed into surrounding tissues. [0068] Figure 21 A depicts an axial view of the sealing means of Figure 20 having enlarging means inserted into the interior cavity. [0069] Figure 21B depicts the construct of Figure 21 in a sagittal section. [0070] Figure 22A shows an alternative fixation scheme for the sealing means and enlarging means. [0071] Figure 22B shows the construct of Figure 22A in a sagittal section with an anchor securing a fixation region of the enlarging means to a superior vertebral body in a location proximate to the defect. [0072] Figure 23 A depicts an embodiment of the barrier means of the present invention being secured to an anulus using fixation means, as shown in one embodiment. [0073] Figure 23B depicts an embodiment of the barrier means of Figure 23A secured to an anulus by two fixation darts wherein the fixation tool has been removed. [0074] Figures 24A and 24B depict a barrier means positioned between layers of the anulus fibrosis on either side of a defect. [0075] Figure 25 depicts an axial cross section of a large version of a barrier means. [0076] Figure 26 depicts an axial cross section of a barrier means in position across a defect following insertion of two augmentation devices. [0077] Figure 27 depicts the barrier means as part of an elongated augmentation device. [0078] Figure 28A depicts an axial section of an alternate configuration of the augmentation device of Figure 27. [0079] Figure 28B depicts a sagittal section of an alternate configuration of the augmentation device of Figure 27. [0080] Figures 29A-D depict deployment of a barrier from an entry site remote from the defect in the anulus fibrosis. [0081] Figures 30A, 30B, 31 A, 3 IB, 32A, 32B, 33 A, and 33B depict axial and sectional views, respectively, of various embodiments of the barrier. [0082] Figure 34 shows a non-axisymmetric expansion means or frame. [0083] Figures 34B and 34C illustrate perspective views of a frame mounted within an intervertebral disc. [0084] Figures 35 and 36 illustrate alternate embodiments of the expansion means shown in Figure 34. [0085] Figures 37A-C illustrate a front, side, and perspective view, respectively, of an alternate embodiment of the expansion means shown in Figure 34. [0086] Figure 38 shows an alternate expansion means to that shown in Figure 37A. [0087] Figures 39A-D illustrate a tubular expansion means having a circular cross-section. [0088] Figures 40A-I illustrate tubular expansion means. Figures 40A-D illustrate a tubular expansion means having an oval shaped cross-section. Figures 40E, 40F and 401 illustrate a front, back and top view, respectively of the tubular expansion means of Figure 40A having a sealing means covering an exterior surface of an anulus face. Figures 40G and 40H show the tubular expansion means of Figure 40A having a sealing means covering an interior surface of an anulus face. [0089] Figures 41A-D illustrate a tubular expansion means having an egg- shaped cross-section. [0090] Figure 42A-D depicts cross sections of a preferred embodiment of sealing and enlarging means. [0091] Figure 43A and 43B depict an alternative configuration of enlarging means. [0092] Figure 44A and 44B depict an alternative shape of the barrier means. [0093] Figure 45 is a section of a device used to affix sealing means to tissues surrounding a defect. [0094] Figure 46 depicts the use of a thermal device to heat and adhere sealing means to tissues surrounding a defect. [0095] Figure 47 depicts an expandable thermal element that can be used to adhere sealing means to tissues surrounding a defect. [0096] Figure 48 depicts an alternative embodiment to the thermal device of Figure 46. [0097] Figures 49A-G illustrate a method of implanting an intradiscal implant. [0098] Figures 50A-F show an alternate method of implanting an intradiscal implant. [0099] Figures 51A-C show another alternate method of implanting an intradiscal implant. [0100] Figures 52 A and 52B illustrate an implant guide used with the intradiscal implant system. [0101] Figure 53A illustrates a barrier having stiffening plate elements. [0102] Figure 53B illustrates a sectional view of the barrier of Figure 53A. [0103] Figure 54A shows a stiffening plate. [0104] Figure 54B shows a sectional view of the stiffemng plate of Figure 54A. [0105] Figure 55A illustrates a barrier having stiffening rod elements. [0106] Figure 55B illustrates a sectional view of the barrier of Figure 55A. [0107] Figure 56A illustrates a stiffening rod. [0108] Figure 56B illustrates a sectional view of the stiffening rod of Figure 56A. [0109] Figure 57 shows an alternate configuration for the location of the fixation devices of the barrier of Figure 44A. [0110] Figures 58A and 58B illustrate a dissection device for an intervertebral disc. [0111] Figures 59A and 59B illustrate an alternate dissection device for an intervertebral disc. [0112] Figures 60A-C illustrate a dissector component. [0113] Figures 61A-D illustrate a method of inserting a disc implant within an intervertebral disc. [0114] Figure 62 depicts a cross-sectional transverse view of a barrier device implanted within a disc along the inner surface of a lamella. Implanted conformable nuclear augmentation is also shown in contact with the barrier. [0115] Figure 63 shows a cross-sectional transverse view of a barrier device implanted within a disc along an imier surface of a lamella. Implanted nuclear augmentation comprised of a hydrophilic flexible solid is also shown. [0116] Figure 64 shows a cross-sectional transverse view of a barrier device implanted within a disc along an inner surface of a lamella. Several types of implanted nuclear augmentation including a solid geometric shape, a composite solid, and a free flowing liquid are also shown. [0117] Figure 65 illustrates a sagittal cross-sectional view of a barrier device connected to an inflatable nuclear augmentation device. [0118] Figure 66 depicts a sagittal cross-sectional view of a functional spine unit containing a barrier device unit connected to a wedge shaped nuclear augmentation device. [0119] Figure 67 shows an anulus augmentation device (such as a mesh) mesh having a series of curvilinear elements. [0120] Figures 68A-G show various profiles and cross-sectional views of an anulus augmentation device (such as a mesh), e.g., "U" shaped, "C" shaped, curvilinear shaped, and "D" shaped to extend along and cover the entire inner anulus surface, or portions thereof. [0121] Figure 69 shows one embodiment of a mesh with curvilinear elements implanted in an intervertebral disc. [0122] Figure 70 shows a wire-type anulus augmentation device. [0123] Figures 71 A-E show a frame (e.g., mesh) that has been encapsulated by a membrane or cover to produce an encapsulated mesh. [0124] Figures 72A-B show a mesh having a double- wishbone frame. [0125] Figures 73A-C shows embodiments of the end or natural hinge portion of the frame, including a looped terminus. [0126] Figures 74A-C show some embodiments of the central band or strut. [0127] Figures 75A-L show an implant an annulus augmentation device such as a mesh having one or more projections extending into the disc or into a defect. [0128] Figure 76 shows an implant comprising a bow-like anterior projection that extends outwardly from a posterior support member. [0129] Figures 77A-H show various cross-sectional side views along a horizontal axis of an implant comprising a bow, band or projection. [0130] Figures 78A-J show various cross-sectional top views of implants along a vertical axis. [0131] Figures 79A-F show a frontal view of a portion of several embodiments of an implant projection. [0132] Figures 80A-D show various cross-sections of an implant projection. [0133] Figures 81 A-D show looped or bent bow-type projections. Detailed Description of the Preferred Embodiment [0134] Several embodiments of the present invention provide for an in vivo augmented functional spine unit. A functional spine unit includes the bony structures of two adjacent vertebrae (or vertebral bodies), the soft tissue (anulus fibrosis (AF), and optionally nucleus pulposus (NP)) of the intervertebral disc, and the ligaments, musculature and connective tissue comiected to the vertebrae. The intervertebral disc is substantially situated in the intervertebral space formed between the adjacent vertebrae. Augmentation of the functional spine unit can include repair of a hemiated disc segment, support of a weakened, tom or damaged anulus fibrosis, or the addition of material to or replacement of all or part of the nucleus pulposus. Augmentation of the functional spine unit is provided by herniation constraining devices and disc augmentation devices situated in the intervertebral disc space. [0135] Figures 1 A and IB show the general anatomy of a functional spine unit 45. h this description and the following claims, the terms 'anterior' and 'posterior', 'superior' and 'inferior' are defined by their standard usage in anatomy, i.e., anterior is a direction toward the front (ventral) side of the body or organ, posterior is a direction toward the back (dorsal) side of the body or organ; superior is upward (toward the head) and inferior is lower (toward the feet). [0136] Figure IA is an axial view along the transverse axis M of a vertebral body with the intervertebral disc 15 superior to the vertebral body. Axis M shows the anterior (A) and posterior (P) orientation of the functional spine unit within the anatomy. The intervertebral disc 15 contains the anulus fibrosis (AF) 10 which surrounds a central nucleus pulposus (NP) 20. A Hemiated segment 30 is depicted by a dashed-line. The hemiated segment 30 protrudes beyond the pre-hemiated posterior border 40 of the disc. Also shown in this figure are the left 70 and right 70' transverse spinous processes and the posterior spinous process 80. [0137] Figure IB is a sagittal section along sagittal axis N through the midline of two adjacent vertebral bodies 50 (superior) and 50' (inferior). Intervertebral disc space 55 is formed between the two vertebral bodies and contains intervertebral disc 15, which supports and cushions the vertebral bodies and permits movement of the two vertebral bodies with respect to each other and other adjacent functional spine units. [0138] Intervertebral disc 15 is comprised of the outer AF 10 which normally surrounds and constrains the NP 20 to be wholly within the borders of the intervertebral disc space, hi Figs. IA and IB, hemiated segment 30, represented by the dashed-line, has migrated posterior to the pre-hemiated border 40 of the posterior AF of the disc. Axis M extends between the anterior (A) and posterior (P) of the functional spine unit. The vertebral bodies also include facet joints 60 and the superior 90 and inferior 90' pedicle that form the neural foramen 100. Disc height loss occurs when the superior vertebral body 50 moves inferiorly relative to the inferior vertebral body 50'. [0139] Partial disruption 121 of the inner layers of the anulus 10 without a true perforation has also been linked to chronic low back pain. Such a disruption 4 is illustrated in Figure IC. It is thought that weakness of these inner layers forces the sensitive outer anulus lamellae to endure higher stresses. This increased stress stimulates the small nerve fibers penetrating the outer anulus, which results in both localized and referred pain. [0140] hi one embodiment of the present invention, the disc herniation constraining devices 13 provide support for returning all or part of the hemiated segment 30 to a position substantially within its pre-hemiated borders 40. The disc herniation constraining device includes an anchor which is positioned at a site within the functional spine unit, such as the superior or inferior vertebral body, or the anterior medial, or anterior lateral anulus fibrosis. The anchor is used as a point against which all or part of the hemiated segment is tensioned so as to return the hemiated segment to its pre-hemiated borders, and thereby relieve pressure on otherwise compressed neural tissue and stmctures. A support member is positioned in or posterior to the hemiated segment, and is connected to the anchor by a connecting member. Sufficient tension is applied to the connecting member so that the support member returns the hemiated segment to a pre-hemiated position. h various embodiments, augmentation material is secured within the intervertebral disc space, which assists the NP in cushioning and supporting the inferior and superior vertebral bodies. An anchor secured in a portion of the functional spine unit and attached to the connection member and augmentation material limits movement of the augmentation material within the intervertebral disc space. A supporting member, located opposite the anchor, may optionally provide a second point of attachment for the connection member and further hinder the movement of the augmentation material within the intervertebral disc space. [0141] Figures 2A and 2B depict one embodiment of device 13. Figure 2A shows the elements of the constraining device in position to correct the hemiated segment. Anchor 1 is securely established in a location within the functional spine unit, such as the anterior AF shown in the figure. Support member 2 is positioned in or posterior to hemiated segment 30. Leading from and connected to anchor 1 is connection member 3, which serves to connect anchor 1 to support member 2. Depending on the location chosen for support member 2, the connection member may traverse tlirough all or part of the hemiated segment. [0142] Figure 2B shows the positions of the various elements of the hemiation constraining device 13 when the device 13 is supporting the hemiated segment. Tightening connection member 2 allows it to transmit tensile forces along its length, which causes hemiated segment 30 to move anteriorly, i.e., in the direction of its pre-hemiated borders. Once hemiated segment 30 is in the desired position, connection member 3 is secured in a permanent fashion between anchor 1 and support member 2. This maintains tension between anchor 1 and support member 2 and restricts motion of the hennated segment to within the pre-hemiated borders 40 of the disc. Support member 2 is used to anchor to hemiated segment 30, support a weakened AF in which no visual evidence of hemiation is apparent, and may also be used to close a defect in the AF in the vicinity of hemiated segment 30. [0143] Anchor 1 is depicted in a representative form, as it can take one of many suitable shapes, be made from one of a variety of biocompatible materials, and be constructed so as to fall within a range of stiffness. It can be a permanent device constructed of durable plastic or metal or can be made from a resorbable material such as polylactic acid (PLA) or polyglycohc acid (PGA). Specific embodiments are not shown, but many possible designs would be obvious to anyone skilled in the art. Embodiments include, but are not limited to, a barbed anchor made of PLA or a metal coil that can be screwed into the anterior AF. Anchor 1 can be securely established within a portion of the functional spine unit in the usual and customary manner for such devices and locations, such as being screwed into bone, sutured into tissue or bone, or affixed to tissue or bone using an adhesive method, such as cement, or other suitable surgical adhesives. Once established within the bone or tissue, anchor 1 should remain relatively stationary within the bone or tissue. [0144] Support member 2 is also depicted in a representative format and shares the same flexibility in material and design as anchor 1. Both device elements can be of the same design, or they can be of different designs, each better suited to being established in healthy and diseased tissue respectively. Alternatively, in other forms, support member 2 can be a cap or a bead shape, which also serves to secure a tear or puncture in the AF, or it can be bar or plate shaped, with or without barbs to maintain secure contact with the hemiated segment. Support member 2 can be established securely to, within, or posterior to the hemiated segment. [0145] The anchor and support member can include suture, bone anchors, soft tissue anchors, tissue adhesives, and materials that support tissue ingrowth although other forms and materials are possible. They may be permanent devices or resorbable. Their attachment to a portion of FSU and hemiated segment must be strong enough to resist the tensional forces that result from repair of the hernia and the loads generated during daily activities. [0146] Connection member 3 is also depicted in representative fashion. Member 3 may be in the format of a flexible filament, such as a single or multi-strand suture, wire, or perhaps a rigid rod or broad band of material, for example. The connection member can further include suture, wire, pins, and woven tubes or webs of material. It can be constructed from a variety of materials, either permanent or resorbable, and can be of any shape suitable to fit within the confines of the intervertebral disc space. The material chosen is preferably adapted to be relatively stiff while in tension, and relatively flexible against all other loads. This allows for maximal mobility of the hemiated segment relative to the anchor without the risk of the supported segment moving outside of the pre-hemiated borders of the disc. The comiection member may be an integral component of either the anchor or support member or a separate component. For example, the comiection member and support member could be a length of non-resorbing suture that is coupled to an anchor, tensioned against the anchor, and sewn to the hemiated segment. [0147] Figures 3 A and 3B depict another embodiment of device 13. In Figure 3A the elements of the hemiation constraining device are shown in position prior to securing a hemiated segment. Anchor 1 is positioned in the AF and connection member 3 is attached to anchor 1. Support member 4 is positioned posterior to the posterior-most aspect of hemiated segment 30. h this way, support member 4 does not need to be secured in hemiated segment 30 to cause hemiated segment 30 to move within the pre-hemiated borders 40 of the disc. Support member 4 has the same flexibility in design and material as anchor 1, and may further take the form of a flexible patch or rigid plate or bar of material that is either affixed to the posterior aspect of hemiated segment 30 or is simply in a form that is larger than any hole in the AF directly anterior to support member 4. Figure 3B shows the positions of the elements of the device when tension is applied between anchor 1 and support member 4 along connection member 3. The hemiated segment is displaced anteriorly, within the pre-herniated borders 40 of the disc. [0148] Figures 4A and 4B show five examples of suitable anchoring sites within the FSU for anchor 1. Figure 4A shows an axial view of anchor 1 in various positions within the anterior and lateral AF. Figure 4B similarly shows a sagittal view of the various acceptable anchoring sites for anchor 1. Anchor 1 is secured in the superior vertebral body 50, inferior vertebral body 50' or anterior AF 10, although any site that can withstand the tension between anchor 1 and support member 2 along coimection member 3 to support a hemiated segment within its pre-hemiated borders 40 is acceptable. [0149] Generally, a suitable position for affixing one or more anchors is a location anterior to the hemiated segment such that, when tension is applied along comiection member 3, hemiated segment 30 is returned to a site within the pre-hemiated borders 40. The site chosen for the anchor should be able to withstand the tensile forces applied to the anchor when the comiection member is brought under tension. Because most symptomatic herniations occur in the posterior or posterior lateral directions, the preferable site for anchor placement is anterior to the site of the hemiation. Any portion of the involved FSU is generally acceptable, however the anterior, anterior medial, or anterior lateral AF is preferable. These portions of the AF have been shown to have considerably greater strength and stiffness than the posterior or posterior lateral portions of the AF. As shown in Figures 4A and 4B, anchor 1 can be a single anchor in any of the shown locations, or there can be multiple anchors 1 affixed in various locations and connected to a support member 2 to support the hemiated segment. Connection member 3 can be one continuous length that is threaded tlirough the sited anchors and the support member, or it can be several individual strands of material each terminated under tension between one or more anchors and one or more support members. [0150] In various forms of the invention, the anchor(s) and comiection member(s) may be introduced and implanted in the patient, with the connection member under tension. Alternatively, those elements may be installed, without introducing tension to the comiection member, but where the comiection member is adapted to be under tension when the patient is in a non-horizontal position, e.g.,. resulting from loading in the intervertebral disc. [0151] Figures 5A-C show an alternate embodiment of hemiation constraining device 13 A. hi this series of figures, device 13 A, a substantially one-piece construct, is delivered through a delivery tube 6, although device 13A could be delivered in a variety of ways including, but not limited to, by hand or by a hand held grasping instrument, hi Figure 5A, device 13A in delivery tube 6 is positioned against hemiated segment 30. hi Figure 5B, the hemiated segment is displaced within its pre-hemiated borders 40 by device 13 A and/or delivery tube 6 such that when, in Figure 5C, device 13A has been delivered through delivery tube 6, and secured within a portion of the FSU, the device supports the displaced hemiated segment within its pre-hemiated border 40. Herniation constraining device 13 A can be made of a variety of materials and have one of many possible forms so long as it allows support of the hemiated segment 30 within the pre-hemiated borders 40 of the disc. Device 13 A can anchor the hemiated segment 30 to any suitable anchoring site within the FSU, including, but not limited to the superior vertebral body, inferior vertebral body, or anterior AF. Device 13 A may be used additionally to close a defect in the AF of hemiated segment 30. Alternatively, any such defect may be left open or may be closed using another means. [0152] Figures 6 depicts the substantially one-piece device 13A supporting a weakened segment 30' of the posterior AF 10'. Device 13A is positioned in or posterior to the weakened segment 30' and secured to a portion of the FSU, such as the superior vertebral body 50, shown in the figure, or the inferior vertebral body 50' or anterior or anterior-lateral anulus fibrosis 10. hi certain patients, there may be no obvious hemiation found at surgery. However, a weakened or tom AF that may not be protruding beyond the pre-hemiated borders of the disc may still induce the surgeon to remove all or part of the NP in order to decrease the risk of hemiation. As an alternative to discectomy, any of the embodiments of the invention may be used to support and perhaps close defects in weakened segments of AF. [0153] A further embodiment of the present invention involves augmentation of the soft tissues of the intervertebral disc to avoid or reverse disc height loss. Figures 7A and 7B show one embodiment of device 13 securing augmentation material in the intervertebral disc space 55. In the left side of Figure 7 A, anchors 1 have been established in the anterior AF 10. Augmentation material 7 is in the process of being inserted into the .disc space along comiection member 3 which, in this embodiment, has passageway 9. Support member 2' is shown ready to be attached to connection member 3 once the augmentation material 7 is properly situated, hi this embodiment, connection member 3 passes through an aperture 11 in support member 2', although many other methods of affixing support member 2' to connection member 3 are possible and within the scope of this invention. [0154] Augmentation material 7 may have a passageway 9, such as a channel, slit or the like, which allows it to slide along the connection member 3, or augmentation material 7 may be solid, and connection member 3 can be tlireaded through augmentation material by means such as needle or other puncturing device. Connection member 3 is affixed at one end to anchor 1 and terminated at its other end by a support member 2', one embodiment of which is shown in the figure in a cap-like configuration. Support member 2' can be affixed to coimection member 3 in a variety of ways, including, but not limited to, swaging support member 2' to comiection member 3. hi a preferred embodiment, support member 2' is in a cap configuration and has a dimension (diameter or length and width) larger than the optional passageway 9, which serves to prevent augmentation material 7 from displacing posteriorly with respect to anchor 1. The right half of the intervertebral disc of Figure 7 A (axial view) and Figure 7B (sagittal view) show augmentation material 7 that has been implanted into the disc space 55 along coimection member 3 where it supports the vertebral bodies 50 and 50'. Figure 7 A shows an embodiment in which support member 2' is affixed to comiection member 3 and serves only to prevent augmentation material 7 from moving off comiection member 3. The augmentation device is free to move within the disc space. Figure 7B shows an alternate embodiment in which support member 2' is embedded in a site in the functional spine unit, such as a hemiated segment or posterior anulus fibrosis, to further restrict the movement of augmentation material 7 or spacer material within the disc space. [0155] Augmentation or spacer material can be made of any biocompatible, preferably flexible, material. Such a flexible material is preferably fibrous, like cellulose or bovine or autologous collagen. The augmentation material can be plug or disc shaped. It can further be cube-like, ellipsoid, spheroid or any other suitable shape. The augmentation material can be secured within the intervertebral space by a variety of methods, such as but not limited to, a suture loop attached to, around, or through the material, which is then passed to the anchor and support member. [0156] Figures 8, 9 A, 9B and 10A and 10B depict further embodiments of the disc hemiation constraining device 13B in use for augmenting soft tissue, particularly tissue within the intervertebral space, hi the embodiments shown in Figures 8 and 9A, device 13B is secured within the intervertebral disc space providing additional support for NP 20. Anchor 1 is securely affixed in a portion of the FSU, (anterior AF 10 in these figures). Comiection member 3 terminates at support member 2, preventing augmentation material 7 from migrating generally posteriorly with respect to anchor 1. Support member 2 is depicted in these figures as established in various locations, such as the posterior AF 10' in Figure 8, but support member 2 may be anchored in any suitable location within the FSU, as described previously. Support member 2 may be used to close a defect in the posterior AF. It may also be used to displace a hemiated segment to within the pre-herniated borders of the disc by applying tension between anchoring means 1 and 2 along comiection member 3. [0157] Figure 9A depicts anchor 1, connection member 3, spacer material 7 and support member 2' (shown in the "cap"-type configuration) inserted as a single construct and anchored to a site within the disc space, such as the inferior or superior vertebral bodies. This configuration simplifies insertion of the embodiments depicted in Figures 7 and 8 by reducing the number of steps to achieve implantation. Coimection member 3 is preferably relatively stiff in tension, but flexible against all other loads. Support member 2' is depicted as a bar element that is larger than passageway 9 in at least one plane. [0158] Figure 9B depicts a variation on the embodiment depicted in Figure 9 A. Figure 9B shows substantially one-piece disc augmentation device 13C, secured in the intervertebral disc space. Device 13C has anchor 1, coimection member 3 and augmentation material 7. Augmentation material 7 and anchor 1 could be pre-assembled prior to insertion into the disc space 55 as a single construct. Alternatively, augmentation material 7 could be inserted first into the disc space and then anchored to a portion of the FSU by anchor 1. [0159] Figures 10A and 10B show yet another embodiment of the disclosed invention, 13D. In Figure 10A, two connection members 3 and 3' are attached to anchor 1. Two ' plugs of augmentation material 7 and 7 are inserted into the disc space along connection members 3 and 3'. Connection members 3 and 3' are then bound together (e.g., knotted together, fused, or the like). This forms loop 3" that serves to prevent augmentation materials 7 and 7' from displacing posteriorly. Figure 10B shows the position of the augmentation material 7 after it is secured by the loop 3" and anchor 1. Various combinations of augmentation material, connecting members and anchors can be used in this embodiment, such as using a single plug of augmentation material, or two comiection members leading from anchor 1 with each of the connection members being bound to at least one other comiection member. It could further be accomplished with more than one anchor with at least one comiection member leading from each anchor, and each of the connection members being bound to at least one other comiection member. [0160] Any of the devices described herein can be used for closing defects in the AF whether created surgically or during the herniation event. Such methods may also involve the addition of biocompatible material to either the AF or NP. This material could include sequestered or extruded segments of the NP found outside the pre-hemiated borders of the disc. [0161] Figures 11-15 illustrate devices used in and methods for closing a defect in an anulus fibrosis. One method involves the insertion of a barrier or barrier means 12 into the disc 15. This procedure can accompany surgical discectomy. It can also be done without the removal of any portion of the disc 15 and further in combination with the insertion of an augmentation material or device into the disc 15. [0162] The method consists of inserting the barrier 12 into the interior of the disc 15 and positioning it proximate to the interior aspect of the anulus defect 16. The barrier material is preferably considerably larger in area than the size of the defect 16, such that at least some portion of the barrier means 12 abuts healthier anulus fibrosis 10. The device acts to seal the anulus defect 16, recreating the closed isobaric environment of a healthy disc nucleus 20. This closure can be achieved simply by an over-sizing of the implant relative to the defect 16. It can also be achieved by affixing the barrier means 12 to tissues within the functional spinal unit, h one embodiment of the present invention, the barrier 12 is affixed to the anulus surrounding the anulus defect 16. This can be achieved with sutures, staples, glues or other suitable fixation means or fixation device 14. The barrier means 12 can also be larger in area than the defect 16 and be affixed to a tissue or structure opposite the defect 16, e.g., anterior tissue in the case of a posterior defect. [0163] The barrier means 12 is preferably flexible in nature. It can be constracted of a woven material such as Dacron™ or Nylon™, a synthetic polyamide or polyester, a polyethylene, and can further be an expanded material, such as expanded polytetrafluroethylene (e-PTFE), for example. The barrier means 12 can also be a biologic material such as cross-linked collagen or cellulous. [0164] The barrier means 12 can be a single piece of material. It can have an expandable means or component that allows it to be expanded from a compressed state after insertion into the interior of the disc 15. This expandable means can be active, such as a balloon, or passive, such as a hydrophilic material. The expandable means can also be a self-expanding elastically deforming material, for example. [0165] Figures 11 and 12 illustrate a barrier 12 mounted within an anulus 10 and covering an anulus defect 16. The barrier 12 can be secured to the anulus 10 with a fixation mechanism or fixation means 14. The fixation means 14 can include a plurality of suture loops placed tlirough the barrier 12 and the anulus 10. Such fixation can prevent motion or slipping of the barrier 12 away from the anulus defect 16. [0166] The barrier means 12 can also be anchored to the disc 15 in multiple locations, hi one preferred embodiment, shown in Figures 13 and 14, the barrier means 12 can be affixed to the anulus tissue 10 in or surrounding the defect and further affixed to a secondary fixation site opposite the defect, e.g. the anterior anulus 10 in a posterior hemiation, or the inferior 50' or superior 50 vertebral body. For example, fixation means 14 can be used to attach the barrier 12 to the anulus 10 near the defect 16, while an anchoring mechanism 18 can secure the barrier 12 to a secondary fixation site. A connector 22 can attach the barrier 12 to the anchor 18. Tension can be applied between the primary and secondary fixation sites tlirough a connector 22 so as to move the anulus defect 16 toward the secondary fixation site. This may be particularly beneficial in closing defects 16 that result in posterior herniations. By using this technique, the hemiation can be moved and supported away from any posterior neural stmctures while further closing any defect in the anulus 10. [0167] The barrier means 12 can further be integral to a fixation means such that the barrier means affixes itself to tissues within the functional spinal unit. [0168] Any of the methods described above can be augmented by the use of a second barrier or a second barrier means 24 placed proximate to the outer aspect of the defect 16 as shown in Figure 15. The second barrier 24 can further be affixed to the inner barrier means 12 by the use of a fixation means 14 such as suture material. [0169] Figures 16A and 16B depict intervertebral disc 15 comprising nucleus pulposus 20 and anulus fibrosis 10. Nucleus pulposus 20 forms a first anatomic region and extra-discal space 500 (any space exterior to the disc) forms a second anatomic region wherein these regions are separated by anulus fibrosis 10. [0170] Figure 16A is an axial (transverse) view of the intervertebral disc. A posterior lateral defect 16 in anulus fibrosis 10 has allowed a segment 30 of nucleus pulposus 20 to hemiate into an extra discal space 500. hiterior aspect 32 and exterior aspect 34 are shown, as are the right 70' and left 70 transverse processes and posterior process 80. [0171] Figure 16B is a sagittal section along the midline intervertebral disc. Superior pedicle 90 and inferior pedicle 90' extend posteriorly from superior vertebral body 95 and inferior vertebral body 95' respectively. [0172] To prevent further hemiation of the nucleus 20 and to repair any present hemiation, in a preferred embodiment, a barrier or barrier means 12 can be placed into a space between the anulus 10 and the nucleus 20 proximate to the inner aspect 32 of defect 16, as depicted in Figures 17 and 18. The space can be created by blunt dissection. Dissection can be achieved with a separate dissection instrument, with the barrier means 12 itself, or a combined dissection/barrier delivery tool 100. This space is preferably no larger than the barrier means such that the barrier means 12 can be in contact with both anulus 10 and nucleus 20. This allows the barrier means 12 to transfer load from the nucleus 20 to the anulus 10 when the disc is pressurized during activity. [0173] hi position, the barrier means 12 preferably spans the defect 16 and extends along the interior aspect 36 of the anulus 10 until it contacts healthy tissues on all sides of the defect 16, or on a sufficient extent of adjacent healthy tissue to provide adequate support under load. Healthy tissue may be non-diseased tissue and/or load bearing tissue, which may be micro-perforated or non-perforated. Depending on the extent of the defect 16, the contacted tissues can include the anulus 10, cartilage overlying the vertebral endplates, and/or the endplates themselves. [0174] h the preferred embodiment, the barrier means 12 comprises two components — a sealing means or sealing component 51 and an enlarging means or enlarging component 53, shown in Figures 21 A and 2 IB. [0175] The sealing means 51 forms the periphery of the barrier 12 and has an interior cavity 17. There is at least one opening 8 leading into cavity 17 from the exterior of the sealing means 51. Sealing means 51 is preferably compressible or collapsible to a dimension that can readily be inserted into the disc 15 tlirough a relatively small hole. This hole can be the defect 16 itself or a site remote from the defect 16. The sealing means 51 is constracted from a material and is formed in such a manner as to resist the passage of fluids and other materials around sealing means 51 and tlirough the defect 16. The sealing means 51 can be constracted from one or any number of a variety of materials including, but not limited to PTFE, e-PTFE, Nylon™, Marlex ™, high-density polyethylene, and/or collagen. The thickness of the sealing component has been found to be optimal between about 0.001 inches (0.127 mm) and 0.063 inches (1.6 mm). [0176] The enlarging means 53 can be sized to fit within cavity 17 of sealing means 51. It is preferably a single object of a dimension that can be inserted tlirough the same defect 16 through which the sealing means 51 was passed. The enlarging means 53 can expand the sealing means 51 to an expanded state as it is passed into cavity 17. One purpose of enlarging means 53 is to expand sealing means 51 to a size greater than that of the defect 16 such that the assembled barrier 12 prevents passage of material through the defect 16. The enlarger 53 can further impart stiffness to the barrier 12 such that the barrier 12 resists the pressures within nucleus pulposus 20 and expulsion tlirough the defect 16. The enlarging means 53 can be constracted from one or any number of materials including, but not limited to, silicon rabber, various plastics, stainless steel, nickel titanium alloys, or other metals. These materials may form a solid object, a hollow object, coiled springs or other suitable forms capable of filling cavity 17 within sealing means 51. [0177] The sealing means 51, enlarging means 53, or the barrier means 12 constructs can further be affixed to tissues either surrounding the defect 16 or remote from the defect 16. hi the preferred embodiment, no aspect of a fixation means or fixation device or the barrier means 12 nor its components extend posterior to the disc 15 or into the extradiscal region 500, avoiding the risk of contacting and irritating the sensitive nerve tissues posterior to the disc 15. [0178] h a preferred embodiment, the sealing means 51 is inserted into the disc 15 proximate the interior aspect 36 of the defect. The sealing means 51 is then affixed to the tissues surrounding the defect using a suitable fixation means, such as suture or a soft- tissue anchor. The fixation procedure is preferably performed from the interior of the sealing means cavity 17 as depicted in Figures 19 and 20. A fixation delivery instrument 110 is delivered into cavity 17 through opening 8 in the sealing means 51. Fixation devices 14 can then be deployed through a wall of the sealing means 53 into surrounding tissues. Once the fixation means 14 have been passed into surrounding tissue, the fixation delivery instrument 110 can be removed from the disc 15. This method eliminates the need for a separate entryway into the disc 15 for delivery of fixation means 14. It further minimizes the risk of material leaking tlirough sealing means 51 proximate to the fixation means 14. One or more fixation means 14 can be delivered into one or any number of surrounding tissues including the superior 95 and inferior 95' vertebral bodies. Following fixation of the sealing means 51, the enlarging means 53 can be inserted into cavity 17 of the sealing means 51 to further expand the barrier means 12 construct as well as increase its stiffness, as depicted in Figures 21 A and 21B. The opening 8 into the sealing means 51 can then be closed by a suture or other means, although this is not a requirement of the present invention, hi certain cases, insertion of a separate enlarging means may not be necessary if adequate fixation of the sealing means 51 is achieved. [0179] Another method of securing the barrier 12 to tissues is to affix the enlarging means 53 to tissues either surrounding or remote from the defect 16. The enlarging means 53 can have an integral fixation region 4 that facilitates securing it to tissues as depicted in Figures 22A, 22B, 32A and 43B. This fixation region 4 can extend exterior to sealing means 51 either through opening 8 or through a separate opening. Fixation'region 4 can have a hole through which a fixation means or fixation device 14 can be passed. In a preferred embodiment, the barrier 12 is affixed to at least one of the surrounding vertebral bodies (95 and 95') proximate to the defect using a bone anchor 14'. The bone anchor 14' can be deployed into the vertebral bodies 50, 50' at some angle between 0E and 180E relative to a bone anchor deployment tool. As shown the bone anchor 14' is mounted at 90E relative to the bone anchor deployment tool. Alternatively, the enlarging means 53 itself can have an integral fixation device 14 located at a site or sites along its length. [0180] Another method of securing the barrier means 12 is to insert the barrier means 12 through the defect 16 or another opening into the disc 15, position it proximate to the interior aspect 36 of the defect 16, and pass at least one fixation means 14 tlirough the anulus 10 and into the barrier 12. hi a preferred embodiment of this method, the fixation means 14 can be darts 15 and are first passed partially into anulus 10 within a fixation device 120, such as a hollow needle. As depicted in Figures 23 A and 23B, fixation means 25 can be advanced into the barrier means 12 and fixation device 120 removed. Fixation means 25 preferably have two ends, each with a means to prevent movement of that end of the fixation device. Using this method, the fixation means can be lodged in both the barrier 12 and anulus fibrosis 10 without any aspect of fixation means 25 exterior to the disc in the extradiscal region 500. [0181] hi several embodiments of the present invention, the barrier (or "patch") 12 can be placed between two neighboring layers 33, 37 (lamellae) of the anulus 10 on either or both sides of the defect 16 as depicted in Figures 24 A and 24B. Figure 24A shows an axial view while 24B shows a sagittal cross section. Such positioning spans the defect 16. The barrier means 12 can be secured using the methods outlined. [0182] A dissecting tool can be used to form an opening extending circumferentially 31 within the anulus fibrosis such that the barrier can be inserted into the opening. Alternatively, the barrier itself can have a dissecting edge such that it can be driven at least partially into the sidewalls of defect 16, annulotomy 416, access hole 417 or opening in the anulus. This process can make use of the naturally layered structure in the anulus in which adjacent layers 33, 37 are defined by a circumferentially extending boundary 35 between the layers. [0183] Another embodiment of the barrier 12 is a patch having a length, oriented along the circumference of the disc, which is substantially greater than its height, which is oriented along the distance separating the surrounding vertebral bodies. A barrier 12 having a length greater than its height is illustrated in Figure 25. The barrier 12 can be positioned across the defect 16 as well as the entirety of the posterior aspect of the anulus fibrosis 10. Such dimensions of the barrier 12 can help to prevent the barrier 12 from slipping after insertion and can aid in distributing the pressure of the nucleus 20 evenly along the posterior aspect of the anulus 10. [0184] The barrier 12 can be used in conjunction with an augmentation device 11 inserted within the anulus 10. The augmentation device 11 can include separate augmentation devices 42 as shown in Figure 26. The augmentation device 11 can also be a single augmentation device 44 and can form part of the barrier 12 as barrier region 300, coiled within the anulus fibrosis 10, as shown in Figure 27. Either the barrier 12 or barrier region 300 can be secured to the tissues surrounding the defect 16 by fixation devices or darts 25, or be left unconstrained [0185] h another embodiment of the present invention, the barrier or patch 12 may be used as part of a method to aμgment the intervertebral disc, hi one aspect of this method, augmentation material or devices are inserted into the disc through a defect (either naturally occurring or surgically generated). Many suitable augmentation materials and devices are discussed above and in the prior art. As depicted in Figure 26, the barrier means is then inserted to aid in closing the defect and/or to aid in transferring load from the augmentation materials/devices to healthy tissues surrounding the defect. In another aspect of this method, the barrier means is an integral component to an augmentation device. As shown in Figures 27, 28A and 28B, the augmentation portion may comprise a length of elastic material that can be inserted linearly through a defect in the anulus. A region 300 of the length forms the barrier means of some embodiments of the present invention and can be positioned proximate to the interior aspect of the defect once the nuclear space is adequately filled. Barrier region 300 may then be affixed to surrounding tissues such as the AF and/or the neighboring vertebral bodies using any of the methods and devices described above. [0186] Figures 28A and 28B illustrate axial and sagittal sections, respectively, of an alternate configuration of an augmentation device 38. h this embodiment, barrier region 300 extends across the defect 16 and has fixation region 4 facilitating fixation of the device 13 to superior vertebral body 50 with anchor 14'. [0187] Figures 29A-D illustrate the deployment of a barrier 12 from an entry site 800 remote from the defect in the anulus fibrosis 10. Figure 29A shows insertion instrument 130 with a distal end positioned within the disc space occupied by nucleus pulposus 20. Figure 29B depicts delivery catheter 140 exiting the distal end of insertion instrument 130 with barrier 12 on its distal end. Barrier 12 is positioned across the interior aspect of the defect 16. Figure 29C depicts the use of an expandable barrier 12' wherein delivery catheter 140 is used to expand the barrier 12' with balloon 150 on its distal end. Balloon 150 may exploit heat to further adhere barrier 12' to surrounding tissue. Figure 29D depicts removal of balloon 150 and delivery catheter 140 from the disc space leaving expanded barrier means 12' positioned across defect 16. [0188] Another method of securing the barrier means 12 is to adhere it to surrounding tissues tlirough the application of heat, hi this embodiment, the barrier means 12 includes a sealing means 51 comprised of a thermally adherent material that adheres to surrounding tissues upon the application of heat. The thermally adherent material can include thermoplastic, collagen, or a similar material. The sealing means 51 can further comprise a separate structural material that adds strength to the thermally adherent material, such as a woven Nylon™ or Marlex rM. This thermally adherent sealing means preferably has an interior cavity 17 and at least one opening 8 leading from the exterior of the barrier means into cavity 17. A thermal device can be attached to the insertion instrument shown in Figures 29C and 29D. The insertion instrument 130 having a thermal device can be inserted into cavity 17 and used to heat sealing means 51 and surrounding tissues. This device can be a simple thermal element, such as a resistive heating coil, rod or wire. It can further be a number of electrodes capable of heating the barrier means and surrounding tissue through the application of radio frequency (RF) energy. The thermal device can further be a balloon 150, 150', as shown in Figure 47, capable of both heating and expanding the barrier means. Balloon 150, 150' can either be inflated with a heated fluid or have electrodes located about its surface to heat the barrier means with RF energy. Balloon 150, 150' is deflated and removed after heating the sealing means. These thermal methods and devices achieve the goal of adhering the sealing means to the AF and NP and potentially other surrounding tissues. The application of heat can further aid the procedure by killing small nerves within the AF, by causing the defect to shrink, or by causing cross- linking and/or shrinking of surrounding tissues. An expander or enlarging means 53 can also be an integral component of barrier 12 inserted within sealing means 51. After the application of heat, a separate enlarging means 53 can be inserted into the interior cavity of the barrier means to either enlarge the barrier 12 or add stiffness to its structure. Such an enlarging means is preferably similar in make-up and design to those described above. Use of an enlarging means may not be necessary in some cases and is not a required component of this method. [0189] The barrier means 12 shown in Figure 25 preferably has a primary curvature or gentle curve along the length of the patch or barrier 12 that allows it to conform to the inner circumference of the AF 10. This curvature may have a single radius R as shown in Figures 44A and 44B or may have multiple curvatures. The curvature can be fabricated into the barrier 12 and/or any of its components. For example, the sealing means can be made without an inherent curvature while the enlarging means can have a primary curvature along its length. Once the enlarging means is placed within the sealing means the overall barrier means assembly takes on the primary curvature of the enlarging means. This modularity allows enlarging means with specific curvatures to be fabricated for defects occurring in various regions of the anulus fibrosis. [0190] The cross section of the barrier 12 can be any of a number of shapes. Each embodiment exploits a sealing means 51 and an enlarging means 53 that may further add stiffness to the overall barrier construct. Figures 30A and 30B show an elongated cylindrical embodiment with enlarging means 53 located about the long axis of the device. Figures 31A and 3 IB depict a barrier means comprising an enlarging means 53 with a central cavity 49. Figures 32A and 32B depict a barrier means comprising a non- axisymmetric sealing means 51. In use, the longer section of sealing means 51 as seen on the left side of this figure would extend between opposing vertebra 50 and 50'. Figures 33A and 33B depict a barrier means comprising a non-axisymmetric sealing means 51 and enlarger 53. The concave portion of the barrier means preferably faces nucleus pulposus 20 while the convex surface faces the defect 16, annulotomy 416, or access hole 417 and the im er aspect of the anulus fibrosis 10. This embodiment exploits pressure within the disc to compress sealing means 51 against neighboring vertebral bodies 50 and 50' to aid in sealing. The 'C shape as shown in Figure 33 A is the preferred shape of the barrier wherein the convex portion of the patch rests against the interior aspect of the AF while the concave portion faces the NP. Used in this manner, the barrier or patch 12 serves to partially encapsulate the nucleus puposus 20 by conforming to the gross morphology of the imier surface of the anulus 10 and presenting a concave or cupping surface toward the nucleus 20. To improve the sealing ability of such a patch, the upper and lower portions of this 'C shaped barrier means are positioned against the vertebral endplates or overlying cartilage. As the pressure within the nucleus increases, these portions of the patch are pressurized toward the endplates with an equivalent pressure, preventing the passage of materials around the barrier means. Dissecting a matching cavity prior to or during patch placement can facilitate use of such a 'C shaped patch. [0191] Figures 34 through 41 depict various enlarging or expansion devices 53 that can be employed to aid in expanding a sealing element 51 within the intervertebral disc 15. Each embodiment can be covered by, coated with, or cover the sealing element 51. The sealing means 51 can further be woven tlirough the expansion means 53. The sealing element 51 or membrane can be a sealer winch can prevent flow of a material from within the anulus fibrosis of the intervertebral disc through a defect in the anulus fibrosis. The material within the anulus can include nucleus pulposus or a prosthetic augmentation device, such as a hydrogel. [0192] Figures 34 through 38 depict alternative patterns to that illustrated in Figure 33 A. Figure 33 A shows the expansion devices 53 within the sealing means 51. The sealing means can alternatively be secured to one or another face (concave or convex) of the expansion means 53. This can have advantages in reducing the overall volume of the barrier means 12, simplifying insertion through a narrow cannula. It can also allow the barrier means 12 to induce ingrowth of tissue on one face and not the other. The sealing means 51 can be formed from a material that resists ingrowth such as expanded polytetraflouroethylene (e-PTFE). The expansion means 53 can be constracted of a metal or polymer that encourages ingrowth, hi several embodiments, if the e-PTFE sealing means 51 is secured to the concave face of the expansion means 53, tissue can grow into the expansion means 53 from outside of the disc 15, helping to secure the barrier means 12 in place and seal against egress of materials from within the disc 15. [0193] The expansion means 53 shown in Figure 33 A can be inserted into the sealing means 51 once the sealing means 51 is within the disc 15. Alternatively, the expansion means 53 and sealing means 51 can be integral components of the barrier means 12 that can be inserted as a unit into the disc. [0194] The patterns shown in Figures 34 tlirough 38 can preferably be formed from a relatively thin sheet of material. The material may be a polymer, metal, or gel, however, the superelastic properties of nickel titanium alloy (NITINOL) makes this metal particularly advantageous in this application. Sheet thickness can generally be in a range of about 0.1 mm to about 0.6 mm and for certain embodiments has been found to be optimal if between about 0.003" to about 0.015" (0.0762 mm to 0.381 mm), for the thickness to provide adequate expansion force to maintain contact between the sealing means 51 and surrounding vertebral endplates. The pattern may be Wire Electro-Discharge Machined, cut by laser, chemically etched, or formed by other suitable means. [0195] Figure 34 shows an embodiment of a non-axisymmetric expander 153 having a superior edge 166 and an inferior edge 168. The expander 153 can form a frame of barrier 12. This embodiment comprises dissecting surfaces or ends 160, radial elements or fingers 162 and a central strut 164. The circular shape of the dissecting ends 160 aids in dissecting through the nucleus pulposus 20 and/or along or between an inner surface of the anulus fibrosis 10. The distance between the left-most and right-most points on the dissecting ends is the expansion means length 170. This length 170 preferably lies along the inner perimeter of the posterior anulus following implantation. The expander length 170 can be as short as about 3 mm and as long as the entire interior perimeter of the anulus fibrosis. The superior-inferior height of these dissecting ends 160 is preferably similar to or larger than the posterior disc height. [0196] This embodiment employs a multitude of fingers 162 to aid in holding a flexible sealer or membrane against the superior and inferior vertebral endplates. The distance between the superior-most point of the superior finger and the inferior-most point on the inferior finger is the expansion means height 172. This height 172 is preferably greater than the disc height at the inner surface of the posterior anulus. The greater height 172 of the expander 153 allows the fingers 162 to deflect along the superior and inferior vertebral endplates, enhancing the seal of the barrier means 12 against egress of material from within the disc 15. [0197] The spacing between the fingers 162 along the expander length 170 can be tailored to provide a desired stiffness of the expansion means 153. Greater spacing between any two neighboring fingers 162 can further be employed to insure that the fingers 170 do not touch if the expansion means 153 is required to talce a bend along its length. The central strut 164 can connect the fingers and dissecting ends and preferably lies along the inner surface of the anulus 10 when seated within the disc 15. Various embodiments may employ struts 164 of greater or lesser heights and thicknesses to vary the stiffness of the overall expansion means 153 along its length 170 and height 172. [0198] Figure 35 depicts an alternative embodiment to the expander 153 of Figure 34. Openings or slots 174 can be included along the central strut 164. These slots 174 promote bending of the expander 153 and fingers 162 along a central line 176 connecting the centers of the dissecting ends 160. Such central flexibility has been found to aid against superior or inferior migration of the barrier means or barrier 12 when the barrier 12 has not been secured to surrounding tissues. [0199] Figures 34B and 34C depict different perspective views of a preferred embodiment of the expander/frame 153 within an intervertebral disc 15. Expander 53 is in its expanded condition and lies along and/or within the posterior wall 21 and extends around the lateral walls 23 of the anulus fibrosis 10. The superior 166 and inferior 168 facing fingers 162 of expander 153 extend along the vertebral endplates (not shown) and/or the cartilage overlying the endplates. The frame 153 can talce on a 3-D concave shape in this preferred position with the concavity generally directed toward the interior of the intervertebral disc and specifically a region occupied by the nucleus pulposus 20. [0200] The bending stiffness of expander 153 can resist migration of the implant from this preferred position within the disc 15. The principle behind this stiffness- based stability is to place the regions of expander 153 with the greatest flexibility in the regions of the disc 153 with the greatest mobility or curvature. These flexible regions of expander 153 are surrounded by significantly stiffer regions. Hence, in order for the implant to migrate, a relatively stiff region of the expander must move into a relatively curved or mobile region of the disc. [0201] For example, in order for expander 153 of Figure 34B to move around the imier circumference of anulus fibrosis 10 (e.g., from the posterior wall 21 onto the lateral 23 and/or anterior 27 wall), the stiff central region of expander 153 spanning the posterior wall 21 would have to bend around the acute curves of the posterior lateral comers of anulus 10. The stiffer this section of expander 153 is, the higher the forces necessary to force it around these comers and the less likely it is to migrate in this direction. This principle was also used in this embodiment to resist migration of fingers 162 away from the vertebral endplates: The slots 174 cut along the length of expander 153 create a central flexibility that encourages expander 153 to bend along an axis running through these slots as the posterior disc height increases and decreased during flexion and extension, h order for the fingers 162 to migrate away from the endplate, this central flexible region must move away from the posterior anulus 21 and toward an endplate. This motion is resisted by the greater stiffness of expander 153 in the areas directly inferior and superior to this central flexible region. [0202] The expander 153 is preferably covered by a membrane that acts to further restrict the movement of materials tlirough the frame and toward the outer periphery of the anulus fibrosis. [0203] Figure 36 depicts an embodiment of the expander 153 of Figure 33 A with an enlarged central strut 164 and a plurality of slots 174. This central strut 164 can have a uniform stiffness against superior-inferior 166 and 168 bending as shown in this embodiment. The strut 164 can alternatively have a varying stiffness along its height 178 to either promote or resist bending at a given location along the inner surface of the anulus 10. [0204] Figures 37A-C depict a further embodiment of the frame or expander 153. This embodiment employs a central lattice 180 consisting of multiple, fine interconnected struts 182. Such a lattice 180 can provide a structure that minimizes bulging of the sealing means 51 under intradiscal pressures. The orientation and location of these struts 182 have been designed to give the barrier 12 a bend-axis along the central area of the expander height 172. The struts 182 support inferior 168 and superior 166 fingers 162 similar to previously described embodiments. However, these fingers 162 can have varying dimensions and stiffness along the length of the barrier 12. Such fingers 162 can be useful for helping the sealer 51 conform to uneven endplate geometries. Figure 37B illustrates the curved cross section 184 of the expander 153 of Figure 37A. This curve 184 can be an arc segment of a circle as shown. Alternatively, the cross section can be an ellipsoid segment or have a multitude of arc segments of different radii and centers. Figure 37C is a perspective view showing the tliree dimensional shape of the expander 153 of Figures 37A and 37B. [0205] The embodiment of the frame 153 as shown in Figures 37A-C, can also be employed without the use of a covering membrane. The nucleus pulposus of many patients with low back pain or disc herniation can degenerate to a state in which the material properties of the nucleus cause it to behave much more like a solid than a gel. As humans age, the water content of the nucleus declines from roughly 88%) to less than 75%. As this occurs, there is an increase in the cross linking of collagen within the disc resulting in a greater solidity of the nucleus. When the pore size or the largest open area of any given gap in the lattice depicted in Figures 37A-37C is between about 0.05mm2 (7.75xl0"5in2) and about 0.75mm2 (1.16xl0"3in2), the nucleus pulposus is unable to extrude through the lattice at pressures generated within the disc (between about 250 KPa and about 1.8 MPa). The preferred pore size has been found to be approximately 0.15 mm2 (2.33xl0"4 in2). This pore size can be used with any of the disclosed embodiments of the expander or any other expander that falls within the scope of embodiments of the invention to prevent movement of nucleus toward the outer periphery of the disc without the need for an additional membrane. The membrane thickness is preferably in a range of about 0.025 mm to about 2.5 mm. [0206] Figure 38 depicts an expander 153 similar to that of Figure 37A without fingers. The expander 153 includes a central lattice 180 consisting of multiple struts 182. [0207] Figures 39 tlirough 41 depict another embodiment of the expander 153 of some embodiments of the present invention. These tubular expanders can be used in the barrier 12 embodiment depicted in Figure 31 A. The sealer 51 can cover the expander 153 as shown in Figure 31 A. Alternatively, the sealer 51 can cover the interior surface of the expander or an arc segment of the tube along its length on either the interior or exterior surface. [0208] Figure 39 depicts an embodiment of a tubular expander 154. The superior 166 and inferior surfaces 168 of the tubular expander 154 can deploy against the superior and inferior vertebral endplates, respectively. The distance 186 between the superior 166 and inferior 168 surfaces of the expander 154 are preferably equal to or greater than the posterior disc height at the inner surface of the anulus 10. This embodiment has an anulus face 188 and nucleus face 190 as shown in Figures 39B, 39C and 39D. The anulus face 188 can be covered by the sealer 51 from the superior 166 to inferior 168 surface of the expander 154. This face 188 lies against the imier surface of the anulus 10 in its deployed position and can prevent egress of materials from within the disc 15. The primary purpose of the nucleus face 190 is to prevent migration of the expander 154 within the disc 15. The struts 192 that form the nucleus face 190 can project anteriorly into the nucleus 20 when the barrier 12 is positioned across the posterior wall of the anulus 10. This anterior projection can resist rotation of the tubular expansion means 154 about its long axis. By interacting with the nucleus 20, the struts 192 can further prevent migration around the circumference of the disc 15. [0209] The struts 192 can be spaced to provide nuclear gaps 194. These gaps 194 can encourage the flow of nucleus pulposus 20 into the interior of the expander 154. This flow can insure full expansion of the barrier 12 within the disc 15 during deployment. [0210] The embodiments of Figures 39, 40 and 41 vary by their cross-sectional shape. Figure 39 has a circular cross section 196 as seen in Figure 39C. If the superior- inferior height 186 of the expander 154 is greater than that of the disc 15, this circular cross section 196 can defonn into an oval when deployed, as the endplates of the vertebrae compress the expander 154. The embodiment of the expander 154 shown in Figure 40 is preformed into an oval shape 198 shown in Figure 40C. Compression by the endplates can exaggerate the unstrained oval 198. This oval 198 can provide greater stability against rotation about a long axis of the expander 154. The embodiment of Figure 41B, 41C and 41D depict an 'egg-shaped' cross section 202, as shown in Figure 41C, that can allow congraity between the curvature of the expander 154 and the inner wall of posterior anulus 10. Any of a variety of alternate cross sectional shapes can be employed to obtain a desired fit or expansion force without deviating from the spirit of the present invention. [0211] Figures 40E, 40F, and 401 depict the expander 154 of Figures 40A-D having a sealing means 51 covering the exterior surface of the anulus face 188. This sealing means 51 can be held against the endplates and the inner surface of the posterior anulus by the expander 154 in its deployed state. [0212] Figures 40G and 40H depict the expander 154 of Figure 40B with a sealer 51 covering the interior surface of the anulus face 188. This position of the sealer 51 can allow the expander 154 to contact both the vertebral endplates and inner surface of the posterior anulus. This can promote ingrowth of tissue into the expander 154 from outside the disc 15. Combinations of sealer 51 that cover all or part of the expander 154 can also be employed without deviating from the scope of the present invention. The expander 154 can also have a small pore size thereby allowing retention of a material such as a nucleus pulposus, for example, without the need for a sealer as a covering. [0213] Figures 42A-D depict cross sections of a preferred embodiment of sealing means 51 and enlarging means 53. Sealing means 51 has internal cavity 17 and opening 8 leading from its outer surface into internal cavity 17. Enlarger 53 can be inserted through opening 8 and into internal cavity 17. [0214] Figures 43A and 43B depict an alternative configuration of enlarger 53. Fixation region 4 extends tlirough opening 8 in sealing means 51. Fixation region 4 has a through-hole that can facilitate fixation of enlarger 53 to tissues surrounding defect 16. [0215] Figures 44A and 44B depict an alternative shape of the barrier. In this embodiment, sealing means 51, enlarger 53, or both have a curvature with radius R. This curvature can be used in any embodiment of the present invention and may aid in conforming to the curved inner circumference of anulus fibrosis 10. [0216] Figure 45 is a section of a device used to affix sealing means 51 to tissues surrounding a defect, h this figure, sealing means 51 would be positioned across interior aspect 50 of defect 16. The distal end of device 110' would be inserted through defect 16 and opening 8 into the interior cavity 17. On the right side of this figure, fixation dart 25 has been passed from device 110', through a wall of sealing means 51 and into tissues surrounding sealing means 51. On the right side of the figure, fixation dart 25 is about to be passed tlirough a wall of sealing means 51 by advancing pusher 111 relative to device 110' in the direction of the arrow. [0217] Figure 46 depicts the use of themial device 200 to heat sealing means 51 and adhere it to tissues surrounding a defect, h this figure, sealing means 51 would be positioned across the interior aspect 36 of a defect 16. The distal end of thermal device 200 would be inserted through the defect and opening 8 into interior cavity 17. In this embodiment, thermal device 200 employs at its distal end resistive heating element 210 comiected to a voltage source by wires 220. Covering 230 is a non-stick surface such as Teflon tubing that ensures the ability to remove device 200 from interior cavity 17. hi this embodiment, device 200 would be used to heat first one half, and then the other half of sealing means 51. [0218] Figure 47 depicts an expandable thermal element, such as a balloon, that can be used to adhere sealing means 51 to tissues surrounding a defect. As in Figure 18, the distal end of device 130 can be inserted through the defect and opening 8 into interior cavity 17, with balloon 150' on the distal end device 130 in a collapsed state. Balloon 150' is then inflated to expanded state 150, expanding sealing means 51. Expanded balloon 150 can heat sealing means 51 and surrounding tissues by inflating it with a heated fluid or by employing RF electrodes. In this embodiment, device 130 can be used to expand and heat first one half, then the other half of sealing means 51. [0219] Figure 48 depicts an alternative embodiment to device 130. Tins device employs an elongated, flexible balloon 150' that can be inserted into and completely fill internal cavity 17 of sealing means 51 prior to inflation to an expanded state 150. Using this embodiment, inflation and heating of sealing means 51 can be performed in one step. [0220] Figures 49 A through 49G illustrate a method of implanting an intradiscal implant. An intradiscal implant system consists of an intradiscal implant 400, a delivery device or cannula 402, an advancer 404 and at least one control filament 406. The intradiscal implant 400 is loaded into the delivery cannula 402 which has a proximal end 408 and a distal end 410. Figure 49 A illustrates the distal end 410 advanced into the disc 15 tlirough an annulotomy 416. This annulotomy 416 can be tlirough any portion of the anulus 10, but is preferably at a site proximate to a desired, final implant location. The implant 400 is then pushed into the disc 15 through the distal end 410 of the cannula 402 in a direction that is generally away from the desired, final implant location as shown in Figure 49B. Once the implant 400 is completely outside of the delivery cannula 402 and within the disc 15, the implant 400 can be pulled into the desired implant location by pulling on the control filament 406 as shown in Figure 49C. The control filament 406 can be secured to the implant 400 at any location on or within the implant 400, but is preferably secured at least at a site 414 or sites on a distal portion 412 of the implant 400, e.g., that portion that first exits the delivery cannula 402 when advanced into the disc 15. These site or sites 414 are generally furthest from the desired, final implant location once the implant has been fully expelled from the interior of the delivery cannula 402. [0221] Pulling on the control filament 406 causes the implant 400 to move toward the annulotomy 416. The distal end 410 of the delivery cannula 402 can be used to direct the proximal end 420 of the implant 400 (that portion of the implant 400 that is last to be expelled from the delivery cannula 402) away from the annulotomy 416 and toward an inner aspect of the anulus 10 nearest the desired implant location. Alternately, the advancer 404 can be used to position the proximal end of the implant toward an inner aspect of the anulus 20 near the implant location, as shown in Figure 49E. Further pulling on the control filament 406 causes the proximal end 426 of the implant 400 to dissect along the imier aspect of the anulus 20 until the attaclnnent site 414 or sites of the guide filament 406 to the implant 400 has been pulled to the imier aspect of the annulotomy 416, as shown in Figure 49D. h this way, the implant 400 will extend at least from the annulotomy 416 and along the inner aspect of the anulus 10 in the desired implant location, illustrated in Figure 49F. [0222] The implant 400 can be any one of the following (including a combination of two or more of the following): nucleus replacement device, nucleus augmentation device, anulus augmentation device, anulus replacement device, the barrier of the present invention or any of its components, drag carrier device, carrier device seeded with living cells, or a device that stimulates or supports fusion of the surrounding vertebra. The implant 400 can be a membrane which prevents the flow of a material from within the anulus fibrosis of an intervertebral disc through a defect in the disc. The material within the anulus fibrosis can be, for example, a nucleus pulposus or a prosthetic augmentation device, such as hydrogel. The membrane can be a sealer. The implant 400 can be wholly or partially rigid or wholly or partially flexible. It can have a solid portion or portions that contain a fluid material. It can comprise a single or multitude of materials. These materials can include metals, polymers, gels and can be in solid or woven form. The implant 400 can either resist or promote tissue ingrowth, whether fibrous or bony. [0223] The cannula 402 can be any tubular device capable of advancing the implant 400 at least partially through the anulus 10. It can be made of any suitable biocompatible material including various known metals and polymers. It can be wholly or partially rigid or flexible. It can be circular, oval, polygonal, or irregular in cross section. It must have an opening at least at its distal end 410, but can have other openings in various locations along its length. [0224] The advancer 404 can be rigid or flexible, and have one of a variety of cross sectional shapes either like or unlike the delivery cannula 402. It may be a solid or even a column of incompressible fluid, so long as it is stiff enough to advance the implant 400 into the disc 15. The advancer 404 can be contained entirely within the cannula 402 or can extend through a wall or end of the cannula to facilitate manipulation. [0225] Advancement of the implant 400 can be assisted by various levers, gears, screws and other secondary assist devices to minimize the force required by the surgeon to advance the implant 400. These secondary devices can further give the user greater control over the rate and extent of advancement into the disc 15. [0226] The guide filament 406 may be a string, rod, plate, or other elongate object that can be secured to and move with the implant 400 as it is advanced into the disc 15. It can be constracted from any of a variety of metals or polymers or combination thereof and can be flexible or rigid along all or part of its length. It can be secured to a secondary object 418 or device at its end opposite that which is secured to the implant 400. This secondary device 418 can include the advancer 404 or other object or device that assists the user in manipulating the filament. The filament 406 can be releasably secured to the implant 400, as shown in Figure 49G or permanently affixed. The filament 406 can be looped around or through the implant. Such a loop can either be cut or have one end pulled until the other end of the loop releases the implant 400. It may be bonded to the implant 400 using adhesive, welding, or a secondary securing means such as a screw, staple, dart, etc. The filament 406 can further be an elongate extension of the implant material itself. If not removed following placement of the implant, the filament 406 can be used to secure the implant 400 to surrounding tissues such as the neighboring anulus 10, vertebral endplates, or vertebral bodies either directly or through the use of a dart, screw, staple, or other suitable anchor. [0227] Multiple guide filaments can be secured to the implant 400 at various locations, hi one preferred embodiment, a first or distal 422 and a second or proximal 424 guide filament are secured to an elongate implant 400 at or near its distal 412 and proximal 420 ends at attaclnnent sites 426 and 428, respectively. These ends 412 and 420 correspond to the first and last portions of the implant 400, respectively, to be expelled from the delivery cannula 402 when adγanced into the disc 15. This double guide filament system allows the implant 400 to be positioned in the same manner described above in the single filament technique, and illustrated in Figures 50A-C. However, following completion of this first technique, the user may advance the proximal end 420 of the device 400 across the annulotomy 416 by pulling on the second guide filament 424, shown in Figure 50D. This allows the user to controllably cover the annulotomy 416. Tins has numerous advantages in various implantation procedures. This step may reduce the risk of hemiation of either nucleus pulposus 20 or the implant itself. It may aid in sealing the disc, as well as preserving disc pressure and the natural function of the disc. It may encourage ingrowth of fibrous tissue from outside the disc into the implant. It may further allow the distal end of the implant to rest against anulus further from the defect created by the annulotomy. Finally, this technique allows both ends of an elongate implant to be secured to the disc or vertebral tissues. [0228] Both the first 422 and second 424 guide filaments can be simultaneously tensioned, as shown in Figure 50E, to ensure proper positioning of the implant 400 within the anulus 10. Once the implant 400 is placed across the annulotomy, the first 422 and second 424 guide filaments can be removed from the input 400, as shown in Figure 50F. Additional control filaments and securing sites may further assist implantation and/or fixation of the intradiscal implants. [0229] In another embodiment of the present invention, as illustrated in Figures 51A-C, an implant guide 430 may be employed to aid directing the implant 400 through the annulotomy 416, through the nucleus pulposus 10, and/or along the inner aspect of the anulus 10. This implant guide 430 can aid in the procedure by dissecting through tissue, adding stiffness to the implant construct, reducing trauma to the anulus or other tissues that can be caused by a stiff or abrasive implant, providing 3-D control of the implants orientation during implantation, expanding an expandable implant, or temporarily imparting a shape to the implant that is beneficial during implantation. The implant guide 430 can be affixed to either the advancer 404 or the implant 406 themselves. In a preferred embodiment shown in Figures 52A and 52B, the implant guide 430 is secured to the implant 400 by the first 424 and second 426 guide filaments of the first 426 and the second 428 attachment sites, respectively. The guide filaments 424 and 426 may pass through or around the implant guide 430. hi this embodiment, the implant guide 430 may be a thin, flat sheet of biocompatible metal with holes passing tlirough its surface proximate to the site or sites 426 and 428 at which the guide filaments 422 and 424 are secured to the implant 400. These holes allow passage of the securing filament 422 and 424 through the implant guide 430. Such an elongated sheet may ran along the implant 400 and extend beyond its distal end 412. The distal end of the implant guide 430 may be shaped to help dissect through the nucleus 10 and deflect off of the anulus 10 as the implant 400 is advanced into the disc 15. When used with multiple guide filaments, such an implant guide 430 can be used to control rotational stability of the implant 400. It may also be used to retract the implant 400 from the disc 15 should this become necessary. The implant guide 430 may also extend beyond the proximal tip 420 of the implant 400 to aid in dissecting across or tlirough the anulus 10 proximate to the desired implantation site. [0230] The implant guide 430 is releasable from the implant 400 following or during implantation. This release may be coordinated with the release of the guide filaments 422 and 424. The implant guide 430 may further be able to slide along the guide filaments 422 and 424 while these filaments are secured to the implant 400. [0231] Various embodiments of the barrier 12 or implant 400 can be secured to tissues within the intervertebral disc 15 or surrounding vertebrae. It can be advantageous to secure the barrier means 12 in a limited number of sites while still insuring that larger surfaces of the barrier 12 or implant juxtapose the tissue to which the barrier 12 is secured. This is particularly advantageous in forming a sealing engagement with surrounding tissues. [0232] Figures 53-57 illustrate barriers 12 having stiffening elements 300. The barrier 12 can incorporate stiffening elements 300 that ran along a length of the implant required to be in sealing engagement. These stiffening elements 300 can be one of a variety of shapes including, but not limited to, plates 302, rods 304, or coils. These elements are preferably stiffer than the surrounding barrier 12 and can impart their stiffness to the surrounding barrier. These stiffening elements 300 can be located within an interior cavity formed by the barrier. They can further be imbedded in or secured to the barrier 12. [0233] Each stiffening element can aid in securing segments of the barrier 12 to surrounding tissues. The stiffening elements can have parts 307, including through-holes, notches, or other indentations for example, to facilitate fixation of the stiffening element 300 to surrounding tissues by any of a variety of fixation devices 306. These fixation devices 306 can include screws, darts, dowels, or other suitable means capable of holding the barrier 12 to surrounding tissue. The fixation devices 306 can be connected either directly to the stiffening element 300 or indirectly using an intervening length of suture, cable, or other filament for example. The fixation device 306 can further be secured to the barrier 12 near the stiffening element 300 without direct contact with the stiffening element 300. [0234] The fixation device 306 can be secured to or near the stiffening element 300 at opposing ends of the length of the barrier 12 required to be in sealing engagement with surrounding tissues. Alternatively, one or a multitude of fixation devices 306 can be secured to or near the stiffening element 300 at a readily accessible location that may not be at these ends, hi any barrier 12 embodiment with an interior cavity 17 and an opening 8 leading thereto, the fixation sites may be proximal to the opening 8 to allow passage of the fixation device 306 and various instruments that may be required for their implantation. [0235] Figures 53 A and 53B illustrate one embodiment of a barrier 12 incorporating the use of a stiffening element 300. The barrier 12 can be a plate and screw barrier 320. In this embodiment, the stiffening element 300 consists of two fixation plates, superior 310 and inferior 312, an example of which is illustrated in Figures 54 A and 54B with two parts 308 passing tlirough each plate. The parts 308 are located proximal to an opening 8 leading into an interior cavity 17 of the barrier 12. These parts 8 allow passage of a fixation device 306 such as a bone screw. These screws can be used to secure the barrier means 12 to a superior 50 and inferior 50' vertebra. As the screws are tightened against the vertebral endplate, the fixation plates 310, 312 compress the intervening sealing means against the endplate along the superior and inferior surfaces of the barrier 12. This can aid in creating a sealing engagement with the vertebral endplates and prevent egress of materials from within the disc 15. As illustrated in Figures 53 A and 53B, only the superior screws have been placed in the superior plate 310, creating a sealing engagement with the superior vertebra. [0236] Figures 55A and 55B illustrate another embodiment of a barrier 12 having stiffening elements 300. The barrier 12 can be an anchor and rod barrier 322. In this embodiment, the stiffening elements 300 consist of two fixation rods 304, an example of which is shown in Figures 56A and 56B, imbedded within the barrier 12. The rods 304 can include a superior rod 314 and an inferior rod 316. Sutures 318 can be passed around these rods 314 and 316 and through the barrier means 10. These sutures 318 can in turn, be secured to a bone anchor or other suitable fixation device 306 to draw the barrier 12 into sealing engagement with the superior and inferior vertebral endplates in a manner similar to that described above. The opening 8 and interior cavity 17 of the barrier 12 are not required elements of the barrier 12. [0237] Figure 57 illustrates the anchor and rod barrier 322, described above, with fixation devices 306 placed at opposing ends of each fixation rod 316 and 318. The suture 18 on the left side of the superior rod 318 has yet to be tied. [0238] Various methods may be employed to decrease the forces necessary to maneuver the barrier 12 into a position along or within the lamellae of the anulus fibrosis 10. Figures 58A, 58B, 59A and 59B depict two preferred methods of clearing a path for the barrier 12. [0239] Figures 58 A and 58B depict one such method and an associated dissector device 454. hi these figures, the assumed desired position of the implant is along the posterior anulus 452. In order to clear a path for the implant, a hairpin dissector 454 can be passed along the intended implantation site of the implant. The hairpin dissector 454 can have a hairpin dissector component 460 having a free end 458. The dissector can also have an advancer 464 to position the dissector component 460 within the disc 15. The dissector 454 can be inserted through cannula 456 into an opening 462 in the anulus 10 along an access path directed anteriorly or anterior-medially. Once a free-end 458 of the dissector component 460 is within the disc 15, the free-end 458 moves slightly causing the hairpin to open, such that the dissector component 460 resists returning into the cannula 456. This opening 462 can be caused by pre-forming the dissector to the opened state. The hairpin dissector component 460 can then be pulled posteriorly, causing the dissector component 460 to open, further driving the free-end 458 along the posterior anulus 458. This motion clears a path for the insertion of any of the implants disclosed in the present invention. The body of dissector component 460 is preferably formed from an elongated sheet of metal. Suitable metals include various spring steels or nickel titanium alloys. It can alternatively be formed from wires or rods. [0240] Figures 59A and 59B depict another method and associated dissector device 466 suitable for clearing a path for implant insertion. The dissector device 466 is shown in cross section and consists of a dissector component 468, an outer cannula 470 and an advancer or inner push rod 472. A curved passage or slot 474 is formed into an intradiscal tip 476 of outer cannula 470. This passage or slot 474 acts to deflect the tip of dissector component 468 in a path that is roughly parallel to the lamellae of the anulus fibrosis 10 as the dissector component 468 is advanced into the disc 15 by the advancer. The dissector component 468 is preferably formed from a superelastic nickel titanium alloy, but can be constracted of any material with suitable rigidity and strain characteristics to allow such deflection without significant plastic deformation. The dissector component 468 can be formed from an elongated sheet, rods, wires or the like. It can be used to dissect between the anulus 10 and nucleus 20, or to dissect between layers of the anulus 10. [0241] Figures 60A-C depict an alternate dissector component 480 of Figures 59A and 59B. Only the intradiscal tip 476 of device 460 and regions proximal thereto are shown in these figures. A push-rod 472 similar to that shown in Figure 59A can be employed to advance dissector 480 into the disc 15. Dissector 480 can include an elongated sheet 482 with superiorly and inferiorly extending blades (or "wings") 484 and 486, respectively. This sheet 482 is preferably formed from a metal with a large elastic strain range such as spring steel or nickel titanium alloy. The sheet 482 can have a proximal end 488 and a distal end 490. The distal end 490 can have a flat portion which can be flexible. A step portion 494 can be located between the distal end 490 and the proximal end 488. The proximal end 488 can have a curved shape. The proximal end can also include blades 484 and 486. [0242] In the undeployed state depicted in Figures 60A and 60B, wings 484 and 486 are collapsed within outer cannula 470 while elongated sheet 482 is captured within deflecting passage or slot 474. As the dissector component 480 is advanced into a disc 15, passage or slot 478 directs the dissector component 480 in a direction roughly parallel to the posterior anulus (90 degrees to the central axis of sleeve 470 in this case) in a manner similar to that described for the embodiment in Figures 59A and 59B. Wings 484 and 486 open as they exit the end of sleeve 470 and expand toward the vertebral endplates. Further advancement of dissector component 480 allows the expanded wings 484 and 486 to dissect through any connections of nucleus 20 or anulus 10 to the endplates that may present an obstruction to subsequent passage of the implants of the present invention, When used to aid in the insertion of a barrier, the dimensions of dissector component 480 should approximate those of the barrier such that the minimal amount of tissue is disturbed while reducing the forces necessary to position the barrier in the desired location. . [0243] Figures 61A-61D illustrate a method of implanting a disc implant. A disc implant 552 is inserted into a delivery device 550. The delivery device 550 has a proximal end 556 and a distal end 558. The distal end 558 of the delivery device 550 is inserted into an annulotomy illustrated in Figure 61A. The amiulotomy is preferably located at a site within the anulus 10 that is proximate to a desired, final implant 552 location. The implant 400 is then deployed by being inserted into the disc 15 through the distal end 558 of the delivery device 550. Preferably the implant is forced away from the final implant location, as shown in Figure 6 IB. An implant guide 560 can be used to position the implant 400. Before, during or after deployment of the implant 400, an augmentation material 7 can be injected into the disc 15. Injection of augmentation after deployment is illustrated in Figure 61C. The augmentation material 7 can include a hydrogel or collagen, for example. In one embodiment, the delivery device 550 is removed from the disc 15 and a separate tube is inserted into the annulotomy to inject the flowable augmentation material 7. Alternately, the distal end 558 of the delivery device 550 can remain within the annulotomy and the fluid augmentation material 554 injected through the delivery device 550. Next, the delivery device 550 is removed from the annulotomy and the intradiscal implant 400 is positioned over the annulotomy in the final implant location, as shown in Figure 6 ID. The implant 400 can be positioned using control filaments described above. [0244] Certain embodiments, as shown in Figures 62-66, depict anulus and nuclear augmentation devices which are capable of working in concert to restore the natural biomechanics of the disc. A disc environment with a degenerated or lesioned anulus cannot generally support the load transmission from either the native nucleus or from prosthetic augmentation, hi many cases, nuclear augmentation materials 7 bulge through the anulus defects, extrude from the disc, or apply pathologically high load to damaged regions of the anulus. Accordingly, in one aspect of the current invention, damaged areas of the anulus are protected by shunting the load from the nucleus 20 or augmentation materials 7 to healthier portions of the anulus 10 or endplates. With the barrier-type anulus augmentation 12 in place, as embodied in various aspects of the present invention, nuclear augmentation materials 7 or devices can conform to healthy regions of the anulus 10 while the barrier 12 shields weaker regions of the anulus 10. Indeed, the anulus augmentation devices 12 of several embodiments of the present invention are particularly advantageous because they enable the use of certain nuclear augmentation materials and devices 7 that may otherwise be undesirable in a disc with an injured anulus. [0245] Figure 62 is a cross-sectional transverse view of an anulus barrier device 12 implanted within a disc 15 along the inner surface of a lamella 16. Implanted conformable nuclear augmentation 7 is also shown in contact with the barrier 12. The barrier device 12 is juxtapositioned to the innermost lamella of the anulus. Conformable nuclear augmentation material 7 is inserted into the cavity which is closed by the barrier 12, in an amount sufficient to fill the disc space in an unloaded supine position. As shown, in one embodiment, fluid nuclear augmentation 554, such as hyaluronic acid, is used. [0246] Fluid nuclear augmentation 554 is particularly well-suited for use in various aspects of the current invention because it can be delivered with minimal invasiveness and because it is able to flow into and fill minute voids of the intervertebral disc space. Fluid nuclear augmentation 554 is also uniquely suited for maintaining a pressurized environment that evenly transfers the force exerted by the endplates to the anulus augmentation device and/or the anulus. However, fluid nuclear augmentation materials 554 used alone may perform poorly in discs 15 with a degenerated anulus because the material can flow back out tlirough anulus defects 8 and pose a risk to surrounding structures. This limitation is overcome by several embodiments of the current invention because the barrier 12 shunts the pressure caused by the fluid augmentation 554 away from the damaged anulus region 8 and toward healthier regions, thus restoring function to the disc 15 and reducing risk of the extrusion of nuclear augmentation materials 7 and fluid augmentation material 554. [0247] Exemplary fluid nuclear augmentation materials 554 include, but are not limited to, various pharmaceuticals (steroids, antibiotics, tissue necrosis factor alpha or its antagonists, analgesics); growth factors, genes or gene vectors in solution; biologic materials (hyaluronic acid, non-crosslinked collagen, fibrin, liquid fat or oils); synthetic polymers (polyethylene glycol, liquid silicones, synthetic oils); and saline. One skilled in the art will understand that any one of these materials may be used alone or that a combination of two or more of these materials may be used together to form the nuclear augmentation material. [0248] Any of a variety of additional additives such as thickening agents, carriers, polymerization initiators or inhibitors may also be included, depending upon the desired infusion and long-term performance characteristics, hi general, "fluid" is used herein to include any material which is sufficiently flowable at least during the infusion process, to be infused through an infusion lumen in the delivery device into the disc space. The augmentation material 554 may remain "fluid" after the infusion step, or may polymerize, cure, or otherwise harden to a less flowable or nonflowable state. [0249] Additional additives and components of the nucleus augmentation material are recited below, hi general, the nature of the material 554 may remain constant during the deployment and post-deployment stages or may change, from a first infusion state to a second, subsequent implanted state. For example, any of a variety of materials may desirably be infused using a carrier such as a solvent or fluid medium with a dispersion therein. The solvent or liquid carrier may be absorbed by the body or otherwise dissipate from the disc space post-implantation, leaving the nucleus augmentation material 554 behind. For example, any of a variety of the powders identified below may be earned using a fluid carrier. In addition, hydrogels or other materials may be implanted or deployed while in solution, with the solvent dissipating post-deployment to leave the hydrogel or other media behind. In this type of application, the disc space may be filled under higher than ultimately desired pressure, taking into account the absoφtion of a carrier volume. Additional specific materials and considerations are disclosed in greater detail below. [0250] Figure 63 is a cross-sectional transverse view of anulus barrier device 12 implanted within a disc 15 along an inner surface of a lamella 16. Implanted nuclear augmentation 7 comprised of a hydrophilic flexible solid is also shown. Nuclear augmentation materials include, but are not limited to, liquids, gels, solids, gases or combinations thereof. Nuclear augmentation devices 7 may be formed from one or more materials, which are present in one or more phases. Figure 63 shows a cylindrical flexible solid form of nuclear augmentation 7. Preferably, this flexible solid is composed of a hydrogel, including, but not limited to, acrylonitrile, acrylic acid, polyacrylimide, acrylimide, acrylimidine, polyacrylonitrile, polyvinylalcohol, and the like. [0251] Figure 63 depicts nuclear augmentation 7 using a solid or gel composition. If required, these materials can be designed to be secured to surrounding tissues by mechanical means, such as glues, screws, and anchors, or by biological means, such as glues and in growth. Solid but deformable augmentation materials 7 may also be designed to resist axial compression by the endplates rather than flowing circumferentially outward toward the anulus. hi this way, less force is directed at the anulus 10. Solid nuclear augmentation 7 can also be sized substantially larger than the annulotomy 416 or defect 8 to decrease the risk of extrusion. The use of solid materials or devices 7 alone is subject to certain limitations. The delivery of solid materials 7 may require a large access hole 417 in the anulus 10, thereby decreasing the integrity of the disc 15 and creating a significant risk for extrusion of either the augmentation material 7 or of natural nucleus 20 remaining within the disc 15. Solid materials or devices 7 can also overload the endplates causing endplate subsidence or apply point loads to the anulus 10 from comers or edges that may cause pain or further deterioration of the anulus 10. Several embodiments of the present invention overcome the limitations of solid materials and are particularly well- suited for use with liquid augmentation materials 7. The barrier device 12 of various embodiments of this invention effectively closes the access hole 417 and can be adapted to partially encapsulate the augmented nucleus, thus mitigating the risks posed by solid materials. [0252] Solid or gel nuclear augmentation materials 7 used in various embodiments of the current invention include single piece or multiple pieces. The solid materials 7 may be cube-like, spheroid, disc-like, ellipsoid, rhombohedral, cylindrical, or amorphous in shape. These materials 7 may be in woven or non-woven form. Other forms of solids including minute particles or even powder can be considered when used in combination with the barrier device. Candidate materials 7 include, but are not limited to: metals, such as titanium, stainless steels, nitinol, cobalt chrome; resorbable or non- resorbing synthetic polymers, such as polyurethane, polyester, PEEK, PET, FEP, PTFE, ePTFE, Teflon, PMMA, nylon, carbon fiber, Delrin, polyvinyl alcohol gels, polyglycohc acid, polyethylene glycol; silicon gel or rabber, vulcanized rubber or other elastomer; gas filled vesicles, biologic materials such as morselized or block bone, hydroxy apetite, cross- linked collagen, muscle tissue, fat, cellulose, keratin, cartilage, protein polymers, transplanted or bioengineered nucleus pulposus or anulus fibrosus; or various pharmacologically active agents in solid form. The solid or gel augmentation materials 7 may be rigid, wholly or partially flexible, elastic or viscoelastic in nature. The augmentation device or material 7 may be hydrophilic or hydrophobic. Hydrophilic materials, mimicking the physiology of the nucleus, may be delivered into the disc in a hydrated or dehydrated state. Biologic materials may be autologous, allograft, zenograft, or bioengineered. [0253] hi, various embodiments of the present invention, the solid or gel nuclear augmentation material 7, as depicted in Figure 63, are impregnated or coated with various compounds. Preferably, a biologically active compound is used, hi one embodiment, one or more drag carriers are used to impregnate or coat the nuclear augmentation material 7. Genetic vectors, naked genes or other therapeutic agents to renew growth, reduce pain, aid healing, and reduce infection may be delivered in this manner. Tissue in-growth, either fibrous (from the anulus) or bony (from the endplates), within or around the augmentation material can be either encouraged or discouraged depending on the augmentation used. Tissue in-growth may be beneficial for fixation and can be encouraged via porosity or surface chemistry. Surface in-growth or other methods of fixation of the augmentation material 7 can be encouraged on a single surface or aspect so as to not interfere with the normal range of motion of the spinal unit, hi this way, the material is stabilized and safely contained within the anulus 10 without resulting in complete fixation which might cause fusion and prohibit disc function. [0254] Figure 64 is a cross-sectional transverse view of anulus barrier device 12 implanted within a disc 15 along an inner surface of a lamella 16. Several types of implanted nuclear augmentation 7, including a solid cube, a composite cylindrical solid 555, and a free flowing liquid 554 are shown. The use of multiple types of nuclear augmentation with the barrier 12 is depicted in Figure 64. The barrier device 12 is shown in combination with fluid nuclear augmentation 554, solid nuclear augmentation 7, in the form of a cube, and a cross-linked collagen sponge composite 555 soaked in a growth factor. In several embodiments of the present invention, a multiphase augmentation system, as shown in Figure 64, is used. A combination of solids and liquids is used in a preferred embodiment. Nuclear augmentation 7 comprising solids and liquids 554 can be designed to create primary and secondary levels of flexibility within an intervertebral disc space, hi use, the spine will flex easily at first as the intervertebral disc pressure increases and the liquids flows radially, loading the anulus. Then, as the disc height decreases and the endplates begin to contact the solid or gelatinous augmentation material, flexibility will decrease. This combination can also prevent damage to the anulus 10 under excessive loading as the solid augmentation 7 can be designed to resist further compression such that the fluid pressure on the anulus is limited. In a preferred embodiment, use of multiphase augmentation allows for the combination of fluid medications or biologically active substances with solid or gelatinous earners. One example of such a preferable combination is a cross-linked collagen sponge 555 soaked in a growth factor or combination of growth factors in liquid suspension. [0255] In one embodiment, the nuclear augmentation material or device 7, 554 constracted therefrom is phase changing, e.g., from liquid to solid, solid to liquid, or liquid to gel. In situ polymerizing nuclear augmentation materials are well-known in the art and are described in US Patent 6,187,048, herein incorporated by reference. Phase changing augmentation preferably changes from a liquid to a solid or gel. Such materials may change phases in response to contact with air, increases or decreases in temperature, contact with biologic liquids or by the mixture of separate reactive constituents. These materials are advantageous because they can be delivered through a small hole in the anulus or down a tube or cannula placed percutaneously into the disc. Once the materials have solidified or gelled, they can exhibit the previously described advantages of a solid augmentation material. In a preferred embodiment, the barrier device is used to seal and pressurize a phase changing material to aid in its delivery by forcing it into the voids of the disc space while minimizing the risk of extrusion of the material while it is a fluid, hi this situation, the barrier or anulus augmentation device 12 may be permanently implanted or used only temporarily until the desired phase change has occurred. [0256] hi another embodiment, an anulus augmentation device 12 that exploits the characteristics of nucleus augmentation devices or materials to improve its own performance is provided. Augmenting the nucleus 20 pressurizes the intervertebral disc environment which can serve to fix or stabilize an anulus repair device in place. The nucleus 20 can be pressurized by inserting into the disc 15 an adequate amount of augmentation material 1, 554. In use, the pressurized disc tissue and augmentation material 7, 554 applies force on the inwardly facing surface of the anulus augmentation device 12. This pressure may be exploited by the design of the anulus prosthesis or barrier 12 to prevent it from dislodging or moving from its intended position. One exemplary method is to design the inwardly facing surface of the anulus prosthesis 12 to expand upon the application of pressure. As the anulus prosthesis 12 expands, it becomes less likely to be expelled from the disc. The prosthesis 12 may be formed with a concavity facing inward to promote such expansion. [0257] In several embodiments, the anulus augmentation device 12 itself functions as nuclear augmentation 7. hi a preferred embodiment, the barrier 12 frame is encapsulated in ePTFE. This construct typically displaces a volume of 0.6 cubic centimeters, although thicker coatings of ePTFE or like materials may be used to increase this volume to 3 cubic centimeters. Also, the anulus augmentation device may be designed with differentially thickened regions along its area. [0258] Figure 65 depicts a sagittal cross-sectional view of the barrier device connected to an inflatable nuclear augmentation device 455. The barrier device 12 is shown connected via hollow delivery and support tube 425 to an nuclear augmentation sack 455 suitable for containing fluid material 554. The tube 425 has a delivery port or valve 450 that extends through the barrier device and can be accessed from the access hole 417 after the barrier device 12 and augmentation sack 455 has been delivered. This nuclear and anulus augmentation combination is particularly advantageous because of the ease of deliverability, since the sack 455 and the barrier 12 are readily compressed. The connection of the barrier 12 and the augmentation sack 455 also serves to stabilize the combination and prevent its extrusion from the disc 15. The nuclear augmentation 7 may be secured to the anulus augmentation prosthesis 12 to create a resistance to migration of the overall construct. Such attachment may also be performed to improve or direct the transfer of load from the nuclear prosthesis 7 tlirough the anulus prosthesis 12 to the disc tissues. The barrier 12 and augmentation 7 can be attached prior to, during, or after delivery of the barrier 12 into the disc 15. They may be secured to each other by an adhesive or by a flexible filament such as suture. Alternatively, the barrier 12 may have a surface facing the augmentation material 7 that bonds to the augmentation material 7 though a chemical reaction. This surface may additionally allow for a mechanical linkage to a surface of the augmentation material 7. This linkage could be achieved through a porous attachment surface of the barrier 12 that allows the inflow of a fluid augmentation material 7 that hardens or gels after implantation. [0259] Alternatively, the anulus augmentation device 12 and nuclear augmentation material 7 may be fabricated as a single device with a barrier 12 region and a nuclear augmentation region 7. As an example, the barrier 12 may form at least a portion of the surface of an augmentation sack 455 or balloon. The sack 455 may be filled with suitable augmentation materials 7 once the barrier has been positioned along a weakened inner surface of the anulus 10. [0260] The sequence of inserting the barrier 12 and nuclear augmentation 7 in the disc can be varied according to the nuclear augmentation 7 used or requirements of the surgical procedure. For example, the nuclear augmentation 7 can be inserted first and then sealed in place by the barrier device 12. Alternatively, the disc 15 can be partially filled, then sealed with the barrier device 12, and then supplied with additional material 7. In a preferred embodiment, the barrier device 12 is inserted into the disc 15 followed by the addition of nuclear augmentation material 7 through or around the barrier 12. This allows for active pressurization. A disc 15 with a severely degenerated anulus can also be effectively treated in this manner. [0261] hi an alternative embodiment, the nuclear augmentation material 7 is delivered through a cannula inserted through an access hole 417 in the disc 15 formed pathologically, e.g. an anular defect 8, or iatrogenically, e.g. an anuulotomy 416 that is distinct from the access hole 417 that was used to implant the barrier 12. Also, the same or different surgical approach including transpsoas, presacral, transsacral, tranpedicular, translaminar, or anteriorly through the abdomen, may be used. Access hole 417 can be located anywhere along the anulus surface or even through the vertebral endplates. [0262] ha alternative embodiments, the anulus augmentation device 12 includes features that facilitate the introduction of augmentation materials 554 following placement. The augmentation delivery cannula may simply be forcibly driven into an access hole 417 proximal to the barrier 12 at a slight angle so that the edge of the barrier 12 defoπns and allows passage into the disc space. Alternatively, a small, flexible or rigid curved delivery needle or tube may be inserted through an access hole 417 over (in the direction of the superior endplate) or under (in the direction of the inferior endplate) the barrier 12 or around an edge of the barrier 12 contiguous with the anulus 15. [0263] hi several embodiments, ports or valves are installed in the banier 12 device that permit the flow of augmentation material into, but not out of, the disc space. One-way valves 450 or even flaps of material held shut by the intervertebral pressure may be used. A collapsible tubular valve may be fashioned along a length of the banier. In one embodiment, multiple valves or ports 450 are present along the device 12 to facilitate alignment with the access hole 417 and delivery of augmentation material. Flow channels within or on the barrier 12 to direct the delivery of the material 554 (e.g. to the ends of the barrier) can be machined, formed into or attached to the banier 12 along its length. Alternatively, small delivery apertures (e.g. caused by a needle) can be sealed with a small amount of adhesive or sutured shut. [0264] Figure 66 is sagittal cross-sectional view of a functional spine unit containing the barrier device unit 12 connected to a wedge-shaped nuclear augmentation 7 device. Figure 66 illustrates that the geometry of the nuclear augmentation 7 can be adapted to improve the function of the banier. By presenting nuclear augmentation 7 with a wedge-shaped or hemicircular profile towards the interior of the intervertebral disc space, and attaching it in the middle of the barrier device 12 between the flexible finger- like edges of the barrier device, the force exerted by the pressurized environment is focused in the direction of the edges of the barrier device sealing them against the endplates. Accordingly, this wedge-shaped feature improves the function of the device 12. One skilled in the art will understand that the nuclear augmentation material 7 may also be designed with various features that improve its interaction with the banier, such as exhibiting different flexibility or viscosity throughout its volume. For example, in certain applications, it may be preferable for the augmentation 7 to be either stiff at the interface with the barrier 12 and supple towards the center of the disc, or vice versa. The augmentation 7 can also serve to rotationally stabilize the barrier 12. In this embodiment, the augmentation is coupled to the inward facing surface of the banier and extends outward and medially into the disc forming a lever arm and appearing as "T-shaped" unit. The augmentation device 7 of this embodiment can extend from the middle of the disc 15 to the opposite wall of the anulus. [0265] In one embodiment, the anulus augmentation device comprises a mesh. Figure 67 shows one example of a meshed anulus augmentation device, hi one embodiment, a repair mesh that is resilient is provided, i some embodiments, the mesh is particularly advantageous because it can withstand millions of motion cycles within the disc environment, and is resistant to fatigue. In several embodiments, fatigue resistance is accomplished by material properties, structural design, or a combination thereof. For a given material, a fatigue resistant stracture can be designed to distribute the strain of deformation as evenly as possible over as much material as possible so as to minimize stress concentrations that could initiate fatigue cracks. For example, a coiled spring may deform millions of times without failure or cracking because the strain is distributed evenly over a length of metal. For an anulus repair mesh, the same effect maybe achieved by means such as, but not limited to, providing more material for a given deformation site by having mesh members curved throughout their lengths, alternating mesh curves in a sine- wave or zigzag pattern to provide more material and distributed strains, or having longer non linear members such that a given deformation results in less material strain, or pre- shaping the implant to minimize strain at the implantation site. The curvilinear, nonlinear, coiled, or angled members can be interconnected, woven, networked, or emanate from or be attached to rails or members to form a framework or define a mesh or barrier. [0266] In one embodiment, a mesh can be used in a variety of locations in and around the intervertebral disc. It can be placed on an external surface of the anulus, along an endplate, within the anulus, between the anulus and nucleus, within the nucleus, or within both the anulus and nucleus. The mesh can be held in place via counteracting forces of the mesh as it flexes from its unstressed shape to stressed shape or friction with disc tissue, between disc and vertebral body tissue or between disc augmentation material or another implant and disc tissue. The mesh can also have a porosity or macrotexture including ridges, spikes or spirals to increase bioincorporation and fixation. Fixation devices, including but not limited to, sutures, glue, screws, and staples can be used to permanently fix the mesh in place. [0267] In one embodiment, the anulus augmentation device is a banier comprising a membrane and a frame. In some embodiments, the frame is the mesh, hi other embodiment, the mesh is coated with the membrane, hi another embodiment, the anulus augmentation device comprises only a frame. [0268] In one embodiment, the mesh or frame region of the implant can preferably be fonned from a relatively thin sheet of material. The material may be a polymer(including in-situ polymerizing), metal, or gel. However, as discuss infra, the superelastic properties of nickel titanium alloy (NITINOL) makes this metal particularly advantageous in this application. Other materials suitable for this application include one or more of the following: nylon, polyvinyl alcohol, polyethylene, polyurethane, polypropylene, polycaprolactone, polyacrylate, ethylene-vinyl acetates, polystyrene, polyvinyl oxide, polyvinyl fluoride, polyvinyl imidazole, chlorosulphonated polyolefms, polyethylene oxide, polytetrafluoroethylene and nylon, and copolymers and combinations thereof, polycarbonate, Kevlar TM, acetal, cobalt chrome, carbon, graphite, metal matrix composites, stainless steel and other metals, alloys and composites. Some materials may be coated to achieve biocompatibility. These materials can also be used for frames or support member that do not comprise meshes. [0269] hi some embodiments, the mesh or frame designs may have sharp edges or have gaps that may allow for tissue transfer outside of the disc. In one embodiment, a membrane may be secured to one or more sides or portions of the mesh or frame in order to resist transfer of particles across its periphery and outside of the disc or to shield the body from the mesh's sharp edges. Also, a membrane can prevent the flow of a material bounded by the anulus fibrosis of the intervertebral disc through a defect in the anulus fibrosis if the device is positioned across the defect. [0270] In a preferred embodiment, the size of the mesh device is dictated by the particular region of the functional spinal unit sought to be treated. For example, In one embodiment, a mesh intended for coverage the interior surface of the posterior lateral anulus can be about 2 cm to about 4 cm in length and about 2 mm to about 15 mm in height. Likewise, the mesh can be sized to cover the entire exterior or interior surface of a disc. Also, if a defect or weakened segment of the disc is pre-opertively identified, the size of the mesh can be selected to adequately span it in more than one direction. In one embodiment, the mesh is sized such that it spans all directions by at least about 2 mm. The overlap provided by the about 2 mm or more mesh, in some embodiments, provides mechanical means by which the mesh resists extrusion through a defect. Where a case dictates that a device is not available for full coverage of a portion of the anulus, the surgeon can select a mesh, barrier, or patch that is sized such that even if the barrier shifts along an axis in either direction, the selected width ensures that there remains about 2 mm or more of the device beyond the edge of the defect in all positions along that portion of the anulus. hi this way a surgeon can determine a minimum implant size that will still be efficacious. [0271] In one embodiment, the anulus augmentation device, such as a mesh or a membrane/frame combination, has a thiclcness in a range between about 0.025 mm to about 3 mm. Nucleus pulposus particles have been measured at around 0.8 mm2. Accordingly, in one embodiment, the anulus augmentation device, such as a mesh or a membrane/frame combination, has pores slightly smaller (e.g., about 0.05 mm2 to about 0.75 mm2) and still function as a means to prevent extrusion of nuclear material from the disc. Alternatively, one of ordinary skill in the art can through experimentation determine the size of disc particles sought to be contained by the mesh and size the pores slightly smaller. Such a design affords the fluid transfer of other smaller particles and especially water, blood, and other tissue fluids. [0272] In several embodiments, the cross-section of the mesh can be flat, concave, convex or hinged (or flexibly connected) along at least a portion of one or more horizontal axes or vertical axes. One of skill in the art will understand that other cross- sections can also be used in accordance with several embodiments of the invention. [0273] It has been determined that in procedures wherein only a limited amount of nucleus or anulus tissue is removed from a pathologic disc, approximately 0.2 to about 2.0 cc of tissue is typically removed. Accordingly, to replace this volume loss and contribute to the biomechanical function of the spine, spinal implants can be designed to replace this volume (about 0.2 to 2.0 cc) through selection of materials and their dimensions. Accordingly, in one embodiment, an implant having a volume of about 0.2 to about 2.0 cc is provided. The implant can include an anulus augmentation device, a nuclear augmentation device or an anulus augmentation/nuclear augmentation combination device. Preferably, a device having an overall volume of about 0.5 cc is provided because this is the most typical volume removed. Also, greater volumes may be used to further increase the volume of the disc in cases where disc height has decreased over time and the fragments have been metabolized (and thus do not require removal). [0274] In one embodiment, an implant comprising a frame and a membrane is provided. In other embodiments, the implant comprises only one or more membranes. In one embodiment, the implant comprises only one or more frames. The frame may be coated. The membrane (or coating) can be comprised of any suitably durable and flexible material including polymers, elastomers, hydrogels and gels such as polyvinyl alcohol, polyethylene, polyurethane, polypropylene, polycaprolactone, polyacrylate, ethylene-vinyl acetates, polystyrene, polyvinyl oxides, polyvinyl fluorides, polyvinyl imidazole, chlorosulphonated polyolefin, polyethylene oxide, polytetrafluoroethylene, a nylon, silicone, rabber, polylactide, polyglycohc acid, polylactide-co-glycolide, polycaprolactone, polycarbonate, polyamide, polyanhydride, polyamino acid, polyortho ester, polyacetal, polycyanoacrylate, degradable polyurethane, copolymers and derivatives and combinations thereof. Biological materials including keratin, albumin collagen, elastin, prolamines, engineered protein polymers, and derivatives and combinations thereof, may also be used. [0275] hi one embodiment, at least a portion of the anulus augmentation device (e.g., the membrane, mesh, barrier, etc,) can be impregnated with, coated with, or designed to carry and deliver diagnostic agents and/or therapeutic agents. Diagnostic agents include, but are not limited to, radio-opaque materials suitable to permit imaging by MRI or X-ray. Therapeutic agents include, but are not limited to, steroids, genetic vectors, antibodies, antiseptics, growth factors such as somatomedins, insulin-like growth factors, fibroblast growth factors, bone morphogenic growth factors, endothelial growth factors, transforming growth factors, platelet derived growth factors, hepatocytic growth factors, keratinocyte growth factors, angiogenic factors, immune system suppressors, antibiotics, living cells such as fibroblasts, chondrocytes, chondroblasts, osteocytes, mesenchymal cells, epithelial cells, and endothelial cells, and cell-binding proteins and peptides. In other embodiments, the nuclear augmentation device can be impregnated, coated, or designed to cany diagnostic and/or therapeutic agents. [0276] In one embodiment, as shown in Figure 67, a mesh having a series of curvilinear elements 602 is provided, hi one embodiment, the curvilinear elements 602 are interconnected. One of skill in the art will understand that the curvilinear elements 602 can exist independently of each other, or only be partially connected. The interconnections 602 can be distributed to form one or more contiguous horizontal bands, rails, members, struts, or axes 604. Figure 67 shows such a device with a central horizontal axis 604 and "S" shaped curvilinear elements 602. hi one embodiment, the "S" shaped elements 602 tend to distribute the stress generated under compression over a larger area, hi one embodiment, only portions of the "S" move out of plane during loading providing stiffness. In some embodiments, the curvilinear elements are particularly advantageous because they provide flexibility, resilience and/or rigidity. [0277] hi some embodiments, the curvilinear elements 602 can be oriented about 90 degrees (curving in the ventral/dorsal axis) such that the curves appear in the overall horizontal cross-section of the implant, hi other embodiments, the curvilinear elements 602 are substantially flat. The curvilinear elements 602 can also be oriented at any angle (e.g., from about 1 degree to about 179 degrees) from the plane. The mesh 600 can be straight, convex or concave in cross-section. Figures 68A-G show the profile of a mesh with various curvilinear elements. Figures 68D-G show top cross-sectional views of the mesh being elongated "U" shaped, "C" shaped, curvilinear shaped (like a- typical posterior anulus interior surface), and "D" shaped to extend along and cover the entire inner anulus surface, or portions thereof. [0278] Figure 69 shows yet another embodiment of a mesh 600 implanted in an intervertebral disc. Here, the curvilinear elements 602 comprise springs, coils, or telescopic members that are adapted to compress axially (like pneumatic pistons or coil springs) under loading rather than bending and confonning to a tissue surface, e.g. the inner surface of the anulus. One advantage of a spring or coil-type mesh is that the mesh can be fairly rigid and resistant to lateral or transverse force but is flexible enough to span around the curvatures of the disc while maintaining contact with the endplates under compression and expansion. Like other curvilinear elements, the springs or coils can be interconnected, linked in a loose or hinge-like arrangement, attached to a horizontal band or axis, attached to a membrane, or encapsulated within a membrane. [0279] In one embodiment, the mesh may also be configured (e.g., from wire or stock) in a pattern comprising a series of repeating curved peaks and valleys oriented in a lateral manner. Two or more curved wires may be superimposed out of phase such that one peak is inferior to the adjacent wires valley. The two wires can be independent, contiguous and formed from a single wire, connected at one or more points, attached to a membrane, or encapsulated within a membrane. Figure 70 shows a wire-type anulus augmentation device. [0280] As discussed above, an annulus augmentation device can comprise, for example, a frame, a membrane or a frame/membrane combination. Figure 70 shows just the frame, which can be, for example, a wire or mesh-like device. Figures 71A-E show a mesh that has been encapsulated by a membrane or cover to produce an encapsulated mesh 606. Figures 71 C shows a top view cross-section wherein the mesh is elongated U shaped and 7 ID tlirough 7 IF show various side view cross-sections wherein the mesh is straight or possesses varying degrees of concavity. As with other baniers disclosed herein, the membrane or encapsulation material may be of substantial thickness or may be substantially thin. Indeed, the encapsulation material may simply be a coating. [0281] hi another embodiment, as shown in Figures 72A-B, a mesh 600 having a double-wishbone frame with or without membrane cover is provided, hi some embodiments, this design is particularly advantageous because it reduces the compression and stress experienced by the implant under flexion, extension, and lateral bending. Figure 72A shows the frame without a membrane situated along a posterior portion of the disc. The implant (e.g., the frame) can also be placed on the outside of the anulus, within the anulus, between the nucleus and anulus or within the nucleus. Also shown is a defect 16 in the anulus 10 and placement of the frame 600 across the defect and spanning beyond it in more than a single direction. Figure 72B shows the mesh in a perspective view outside of the disc. The frame (e.g., mesh) can be flat or an elongated "U" shaped conesponding to the inner surface of the posterior anulus. In one embodiment, the frame can be a single continuous band or wire forming two ends, a first end and a second end. In one embodiment, each end functions as a living hinge and forms an apex which may be in the form of a curve, a bend, or series of bends such that the wire is generally redirected in the opposite direction. Accordingly, if a load is applied along the vertical axis at the midpoint of the frame, e.g., the midpoint of the top and bottom (superior, inferior) rail, each comer or apex is loaded equally and the wire rails act as levers. [0282] hi one embodiment, the mesh 600 can be implanted such that the midpoint of the mesh frame 600 is in the posterior of the disc and the ends reside medially or even in the anterior portion of the disc, hi this way the portion of the mesh 600 that undergoes the greatest compression is furthest away from each end. Accordingly, a relatively large range of motion can be traversed by the middle of the device but this will only translate to limited motion at each end or living hinge, thus reducing stress and fatigue. Also, by placing each end (which has a relatively small profile) at opposing sides at the midline of the disc (the center of rotation) it is subjected to almost no direct loading under lateral bending, flexion, extension, or compression by the endplates. [0283] Figures 73A-C shows other embodiments for the end or natural hinge portion of the frame (e.g., mesh 600) , including a loop formation. [0284] Figures 74A-C show some embodiments of the central band or strut 604. Figures 74A-B show a central reinforcement band 604 disposed between the ends or apexes of the frame (e.g., mesh). As shown in Figure 74B, the central band 604 can be positioned between the top rail (or wire) 603 and bottom rail (or wire) 605. As shown in Figure 74C, the central band 604 can be elongated to form a concave cross-section between the top and bottom rail or wire. [0285] hi several embodiments of the invention, an implant (e.g., an anulus augmentation device, such as a mesh) can exhibit different mechanical properties along various axes. For example, an implant can exhibit rigidity along a first axis and flexibility (or less rigidity) along a second axis transverse or perpendicular to the first. Such an implant might find particular utility along the wall of an anulus between two adjacent vertebrae because such an environment will subject the implant to vertical compression (e.g., along the superior/inferior axis) yet will not compress the implant laterally. As such, the implant can retain its rigidity along its horizontal axis. Rigidity along the horizontal axis of anulus augmentation device is especially useful in some embodiments if the implant is placed in front of a weakened or defective surface of the anulus because a point load will like form at that region when the disc is compressed under loading and could cause the implant to bend and extrude. Accordingly, an implant having a certain degree of rigidity along its lateral axis resists such bending and extrusion. Moreover, because of the less rigid and more flexible behavior of the implant along its vertical axis loads caused flexion and extension of the spine will allow the implant to flex naturally with the spine and not injure the endplates. [0286] hi some embodiments, to achieve the differences in mechanical properties, any number of construction, material selection or fabrication techniques known in the art can be used. For example, the implant may be made thicker or thinner at points along a particular axis or voids or patterns may be cut into the material. Also, a composite implant having different material sandwiched together can also be used. Struts, members, rails and the like may be added to, secured to, or integral to the implant to provide stiffness and rigidity. Further, such stiffening elements can be added during the implantation procedure. [0287] hi one embodiment, the implant can also be corrugated along an axis or otherwise be provided with bents or curves to provide stiffness. A gentle curve or "C" shaped cross-section that could also conform or correspond to the imier curved surface of an anulus is also preferable for making a seal with the anulus and for resisting bending along the implant horizontal axis e.g., the curve would resist flattening out, flexing or bending laterally. Also, in some embodiments the implant can be oversized such that it remains in compression along one or more of its axes in its implanted state such that even under flexion and extension of the spine the corrugations or curved sections never flatten out and thus retain rigidity (or less flexibility) along an axis perpendicular to the curves. [0288] One of skill in the art will understand that, in several embodiments, the implant (e.g., an anulus augmentation device, such as a mesh) can be more or less rigid or flexible, according to the preference of the practitioner or disc environment. The degree of desired rigidity and flexibility along each axis can be determined based on factors such as defect size, intervertebral pressure, implant deliverability, desired degree of compression and disc height. [0289] According to one embodiment of the invention, an implant has a "C" cross-section, a central rail and top and bottom rails, and curvilinear elements comiect the rails. The frame or mesh can be comprised of any of the suitable materials discussed herein, (e.g. nickel titanium) and can also be coated, covered, bonded, or coupled to a cover or membrane. In one embodiment, the implant is more rigid along its lateral axis because of its "C" cross-section or the rails and less rigid along its vertical axis because of the void caused by the pattern and lack of corrugations or stiffening elements. [0290] Though some embodiments of the invention disclose a mesh frame, patch, plate, biocompatible support member or barrier adapted to extend along the imier circumference of an anulus fibrosus, other embodiments contemplate partial coverage of the anulus or tissue surface. For some embodiments that that cover less than the entire inner surface of the anulus or that are not fully anchored in place, and are susceptible to migration, one or more projections extending outward from, or off-angle to the implant can be configured to resist migration or movement of the implant within the disc under cyclical loading and movement of the spine. One advantage of such embodiments is that they can reduce or prevent migration. Undesired migration may render the implant ineffective or cause it to pathologically interfere with adjacent tissue including the anulus, nucleus, endplates and spinal cord. [0291] According to one embodiment, an implant can be stabilized within an intervertebral disc by providing a support member or patch with an off-angle projection functioning as a lever arm or keel. In some embodiments, even a slightly angled projection (e.g., about 5 to about 10 degrees) can serve to reduce the tendency of the device to rotate or migrate if it has sufficient surface area and length (about 3 mm to about 30 mm). As shown previously in Figures 25 and 34, one embodiment of an anulus augmentation device can have one or more comers, sides or projections connected at the opposing end of the devices midsection or middle portion. Such a configuration is especially effective when implanted into an intervertebral disc such that the midsection of the barrier is inserted along the posterior anulus and the comers and side projections are inserted along the posterio- lateral corners and lateral anulus respectively, hi one embodiment, the comer sections extend away from the posterior anulus toward the anterior of the disc. The projections that project away from the posterior anulus at an angle (about 90 degrees or through a radius of curvature resulting in an angle from about 30 to about 150 degrees) are substantially parallel with or adjacent to the lateral anulus. Thus, the projection portion of the implant in its implanted orientation is at once off-angle to the posterior anulus or midsection of the barrier and parallel to the lateral anulus. Because the anulus defines a bounded area such a projection may indeed collide with or be parallel with another adjacent or opposing surface of the anulus but still function to stabilize the device along the other surface. The device can also be designed with one or more projections that are angled toward the medial, anterior, posterior, or lateral portion of the disc such that the projection contacts mostly or exclusively nucleus tissue or endplate. For example, a looped projection connected at the top and bottom and/or opposing ends of the support member, frame, or patch can be configured to extend across the disc from about 3 mm to about 30 mm and only contact nucleus tissue, hi another embodiment, one or more projections can be oriented into a defect in the anulus and occupy less than or all of its volume, hi another embodiment, a projection situated within a defect may be anchored into an endplate adjacent the defect. Figures 75A-L show an implant 610 (e.g., an annulus augmentation device such as a mesh) having one or more projections extending into the disc or into a defect. [0292] A stabilizing projection according to one or more embodiments of the invention can be integral or affixed to the surgical mesh, patch, plate, biocompatible support member or banier device. The stabilizing projection can also be independent of or coupled to at least a portion of the frame or the membrane. The stabilizing projection can be constructed from the same material as the frame or the membrane, or it can be constracted from different material. The stabilizing projection can extend from any point or points along the device or device frame including its opposing ends, mid-section, along the top edge or along the bottom edge. The projection can also form a loop in one or more planes including parallel and peφendicular to the face of the device. For example, in one embodiment opposing end projections are connected to, or are integral to, the barrier and extend out from the barrier at an angle from about 0 to about 160 degrees, hi another embodiment, the projections are joined or are simply contiguous and form a bow-shaped or curved projection extending away from the banier. In this embodiment, the banier can be placed along a portion of the anulus and the bow would extend medially into the disc. In another embodiment, the barrier can be placed along at least a portion of the posterior anulus and the bowed projection, attached at the opposing ends of the barrier frame or membrane, would extend toward the anterior of the disc. [0293] Figure 76 shows an implant 610 according to one embodiment of the invention. Here, a bow-like anterior projection 612 extends outwardly from a posterior support member 614 (e.g., a patch, banier or mesh). The projection 612 can be comiected at each end of the posterior support member 614 along its horizontal axis. The projection 612 can be attached at any point along the vertical axis of the end including its midline, ends, or its entirety. The projection 612 may be integral to the posterior support member 614 such that the posterior support member 614 is simply formed as a band or attached separately. As shown the implant 610 can be shaped like a bow. The bow can be a gentle arc, curved, re-curved one or more times, triangular, rectangular, octagonal, linked multiple sided, oval or circular. Though in some embodiments, an arc or smooth bow may be advantageous for transfening loads evenly, a rigid mid-section portion or a comparatively flexible hinge-like mid-section along the bow is also presented. The mid-section of the bow projection can have a different height than the remainder of the bow and be the same or different (less than or greater than) height than the midsection patch or biocompatible support member portion of the device. [0294] Various embodiments of the bow or arcurate member or projection 612 can act like a spring to aid in holding the ends of the patch open and against the anulus wall. Similarly, in one embodiment, the profile of the projection 612 can provide resistance to anterior travel of the implant through the nucleus or through the opposite wall of the anulus. hi another embodiment of the invention, the projection or stabilizer 612 can also provide torsional resistance to the barrier 614. Finally, because the projection or bow 612 extends across the endplates it creates an elongated profile functioning as a lever arm and thus resists rotation along the anulus wall within the disc. [0295] The projection, bow or band portion 612 of the implant 610 can be tubular, wire-like, flat, mesh-like, curvilinear, bent, comprised of one or more rails, or contain voids. The bow can define concavities facing inward or outward and be opposite or the same as the concavities defined by the biocompatible support member portion 614 of the implant 610. The projection 612 can simply be angled projections of the biocompatible support member and be made of the same material and have the same properties. Alternatively the projection can have different properties such as less flexibility or more rigidity along one or more axes. Although one projection is shown in Figure 76, more than one bow-like projections may be used. [0296] Different bow or loop projection profiles may be useful for retaining nucleus tissue within the area bounded by the implant, soft anchoring to the nucleus or at least resisting travel through or along the nucleus, or for mechanically displacing nucleus tissue. Mechanical displacement (tlirough pinching or pressing) of the nucleus can increase disc height and serve to more uniformly load the anulus and improve the perfonnance of the implant. Also, the gap within the disc created by the bow or projection can be left vacant or filled in with suitable nucleus augmentation either tlirough, or around a periphery of the implant. The bow projection 612 can also act as a piston or shock absorber that deforms under compressive loading of the disc relieving some of the load on the anulus caused by the nucleus being compressed between the endplates. [0297] The stabilizing projection 612 can be made of the same material as the biocompatible support member 614 (e.g., barrier, patch or mesh). In one embodiment, the stabilizing projection 612 is an off-angle projection of the biocompatible support member 614 and forms a continuous loop or band, hi another embodiment, the stabilizing projection 612 can be made of a different biocompatible material, including polymers, metals, bio-materials, and grafts. [0298] Figures 77A-H show various cross-sectional side views of an implant 610 along a horizontal axis according to one or more embodiments of the invention. Accordingly, a bow, band or projection can be uniform in height or non-uniform. It can be the same height, shorter or taller than the patch portion of the implant. For example, in one embodiment, a projection is narrow at the point where it connects to the posterior support member component of the implant and then flairs near the midline of the anterior bow until its height exceeds the posterior member height. Such a configuration might be favorable between cupped or concave vertebral endplates when the posterior member portion of the implant is positioned against the posterior anulus. Further, in one or more embodiments of the invention, a projection can have different mechanical properties than the support member or patch section of the implant. For example, in one embodiment, a projection is more or less flexible along one or more axes compared to the patch or biocompatible support member portion of the implant. In another embodiments, a projection can be concave along one or more axes, or can have variable regions of concavity along the same axis. [0299] Figures 78A-J show various cross-sectional top views of implants 610 along a vertical axis according to some embodiments of the invention. For example, Figure 78G shows an implant (e.g., an anulus augmentation device such as a mesh) that has a puckered bow-like projection that is well-suited for disc moφhology. [0300] Figures 79A-F show a frontal view of a portion of various embodiments of projections according to one or more embodiments of the invention. [0301] Figures 80A-D show various cross-sections of projection 612, according to some embodiments of the invention. [0302] Figures 81A-D show looped or bent bow-type projections 612 that are contiguous or integral with, or are connected to the biocompatible support member 614 at two or more points along a vertical or horizontal axis. Figure 81 A shows a criss-cross loop projection. Figure 81B shows a strap-like projection. Figure 81C shows a projection that is integral with the support member such that the implant forms a circular band that serves to stabilize the device. Figure 8 ID shows a box-frame type projection. [0303] One skilled in the art will appreciate that any of the above procedures involving nuclear augmentation and/or anulus augmentation may be performed with or without the removal of any or all of the autologous nucleus. Further, the nuclear augmentation materials and/or the anulus augmentation device may be designed to be safely and efficiently removed from the intervertebral disc in the event they are no longer required. [0304] While this invention has been particularly shown and described with references to prefened embodiments thereof, it will be understood by those skilled in the art that various changes in form and details may be made therein without departing from the scope of the invention encompassed by the appended claims.

Claims

What is claimed is: 1. A anulus augmentation device for reinforcing an intervertebral disc comprising: a mesh frame, wherein said mesh frame comprises a plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members, wherein said plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members are adapted to provide flexibility and resilience to said mesh frame; and a membrane, wherein said membrane covers at least a portion of said mesh frame. 2. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members comprise a metal alloy selected from group consisting of one or more of the following: steel, nickel titanium, and cobalt chrome. 3. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said plurality of flexible intercomiected curvilinear members comprise a material selected from group consisting of one or more of the following: nylon, polyvinyl alcohol, polyethylene, polyurethane, polypropylene, polycaprolactone, polyacrylate, ethylene-vinyl acetate, polystyrene, polyvinyl oxide, polyvinyl fluoride, polyvinyl imidazoles, chlorosulphonated polyolefm, polyethylene oxide, polytetrafluoroethylene, acetal, poly(p- phenyleneterephtalamide) (Kevlar™), poly carbonate, carbon, and graphite. 4. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said membrane comprises a material selected from a group consisting of one or more of the following: polymers, elastomers, and gels. 5. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said membrane comprises a material selected from a group consisting of one or more of the following: elastin, albumin, collagen, fibrin and keratin. 6. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said membrane comprises a material selected from a group consisting of one or more of the following: antibodies, antiseptics, genetic vectors, bone moφhogenic proteins, steroids, cortisones, and growth factors. 7. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said membrane is a coating material.
8. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, where at least a portion of said plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members form a horizontal member or central strut. 9. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, where said plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members are arranged in a parallel configuration. 10. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said mesh frame is concave along at least a portion of at least one axis of said mesh frame. 11. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said mesh frame has a length in the range of about 0.5 cm to about 5 cm. 12. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said mesh frame is sized to cover at least a portion of an interior surface of an anulus lamella. 13. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein said mesh frame is adapted to extend circumferentially along the entire surface of an anulus lamella. 14. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, further comprising at least one projection that radiates from the mesh frame. 15. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein the mesh frame has a vertical cross-section of a shape selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: flat, concave, convex, and curvilinear. 16. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 1, wherein the mesh frame has a horizontal cross-section of a shape selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: concave, convex, flat, and kidney bean. 17. A anulus augmentation device for reinforcing an intervertebral disc comprising: a mesh frame, wherein said mesh fame comprises a plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members, wherein said plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members are adapted to provide flexibility and resilience to said mesh frame, and wherein said mesh fame is concave along at least a portion of at least one axis. 18. A anulus augmentation device for reinforcing an intervertebral disc comprising: a mesh frame, wherein said mesh frame comprises a plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members, wherein said plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members are adapted to provide flexibility and resilience to said mesh frame; and a membrane, wherein said membrane is coupled to at least a portion of said mesh frame. 19. A anulus augmentation device for reinforcing an intervertebral disc comprising: a mesh frame having a horizontal axis and a vertical axis, wherein said mesh fame is concave along at least a portion said horizontal axis or said vertical axis; and a plurality of projections radiating from said horizontal axis or said vertical axis, wherein said plurality of projections are adapted to stabilize the anulus augmentation device. 20. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, wherein said at least one projection has at least dimension that is larger than said horizontal axis or said vertical axis. 21. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, wherein said mesh frame comprises a plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members, wherein said plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members are adapted to provide flexibility and resilience to said mesh frame. 22. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, wherein said mesh frame comprise a material selected from group consisting of one or more of the following: nylon, polyvinyl alcohol, polyethylene, polyurethane, polypropylene, polycaprolactone, polyacrylate, ethylene-vinyl acetate, polystyrene, polyvinyl oxide, polyvinyl fluoride, polyvinyl imidazoles, chlorosulphonated polyolefm, polyethylene oxide, polytetrafluoroethylene, acetal, poly(p-phenyleneterephtalamide) (Kevlar™), poly carbonate, carbon, and graphite. 23. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, further comprising a membrane, wherein said membrane covers at least a portion of said mesh frame.
24. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 23, wherein said membrane comprises a material selected from a group consisting of one or more of the following: polymers, elastomers, and gels. 25. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 23, wherein said membrane comprises a material selected from a group consisting of one or more of the following: elastin, albumin, collagen, fibrin and keratin. 26. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 23, wherein said membrane comprises a material selected from a group consisting of one or more of the following: antibodies, antiseptics, genetic vectors, bone moφhogenic proteins, steroids, cortisones, and growth factors. 27. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 23, wherein said membrane is a coating material. 28. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, further comprising a plurality of flexible interconnected curvilinear members that fonn a horizontal band or central strut. 29. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, wherein said mesh frame has a length in the range of about 0.5 cm to about 5 cm. 30. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 119, wherein said mesh frame is sized to cover at least a portion of an interior surface of an anulus lamella. 31. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, wherein said mesh frame is adapted to extend circumferentially along the entire surface of an anulus lamella. 32. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, further comprising at least one projection that radiates from the mesh frame. 33. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, wherein the mesh frame has a vertical cross-section of a shape selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: flat, concave, convex, and curvilinear. 34. The anulus augmentation device of Claim 19, wherein the mesh frame has a horizontal cross-section of a shape selected from the group consisting of one or more of the following: concave, convex, flat, and kidney bean. 35. An intervertebral disc implant comprising a posterior support member having a first terminus and a second tenninus; an anterior projection that extends outwardly from said posterior support member, wherein said anterior projection is attached to at least the first terminus or the second terminus of said a posterior support member. 36. An intervertebral disc implant comprising a posterior support member having a first terminus and a second terminus; an anterior projection having a first end and a second end, wherein said anterior projection extends outwardly from said posterior support member, wherein the first end of the anterior projection is coupled to the first terminus of the posterior support member; and wherein the second end of the anterior projection is coupled to the second terminus of the posterior support member, thereby substantially forming a bow- shaped implant. 37. A fatigue-resistant surgical mesh comprising: a top rail; a bottom rail coupled to said top rail, wherein said top rail and said bottom rail are coupled to each other at a first end and second end; and wherein said top rail and said bottom rail extend to form a gap that is defined between said rails along at least a portion of the distance between the ends. 38. An spinal implant for treatment of an intervertebral disc comprising: a barrier or patch with a volume corresponding to the amount of material removed during a discectomy procedure, wherein said volume is between about 0.2 cc to about 2 cc. 39. A method of repairing defective regions within a spinal disc comprising: providing a surgical mesh; implanting said surgical mesh along an anulus surface; and positioning said surgical mesh at least such that about 2 mm of the device spans beyond at least one edge of the defective region of the disc. 40. An intervertebral disc implant comprising: a banier forming a contiguous band having one or more portions along said band having a different height and wherein one or more portions of said band have different degrees of flexibility along an axis.
EP04795837A 2003-10-22 2004-10-21 Stabilized intervertebral disc barrier Withdrawn EP1686929A4 (en)

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US51343703P 2003-10-22 2003-10-22
US61395804P 2004-09-28 2004-09-28
PCT/US2004/034729 WO2005041813A2 (en) 2003-10-22 2004-10-21 Stabilized intervertebral disc barrier

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
EP1686929A2 EP1686929A2 (en) 2006-08-09
EP1686929A4 true EP1686929A4 (en) 2009-05-06

Family

ID=34555902

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
EP04795837A Withdrawn EP1686929A4 (en) 2003-10-22 2004-10-21 Stabilized intervertebral disc barrier

Country Status (4)

Country Link
EP (1) EP1686929A4 (en)
JP (1) JP2007527273A (en)
CA (1) CA2543121A1 (en)
WO (1) WO2005041813A2 (en)

Families Citing this family (11)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7972337B2 (en) * 2005-12-28 2011-07-05 Intrinsic Therapeutics, Inc. Devices and methods for bone anchoring
US20040054414A1 (en) 2002-09-18 2004-03-18 Trieu Hai H. Collagen-based materials and methods for augmenting intervertebral discs
US7744651B2 (en) 2002-09-18 2010-06-29 Warsaw Orthopedic, Inc Compositions and methods for treating intervertebral discs with collagen-based materials
JP2006515765A (en) 2002-11-15 2006-06-08 エスディージーアイ・ホールディングス・インコーポレーテッド Collagen-based materials and methods for treating synovial joints
US20070191956A1 (en) * 2006-02-10 2007-08-16 Replication Medical, Inc. Radially extended support member for spinal nucleus implants and methods of use
US8118779B2 (en) 2006-06-30 2012-02-21 Warsaw Orthopedic, Inc. Collagen delivery device
US8399619B2 (en) 2006-06-30 2013-03-19 Warsaw Orthopedic, Inc. Injectable collagen material
JP4995978B2 (en) * 2011-03-15 2012-08-08 宏美 林 Treatment method of living body excluding human body
CN106983586B (en) * 2017-04-28 2019-01-18 宁波华科润生物科技有限公司 A kind of vertebral fusion system through minimally invasive access approach
CN107049564B (en) * 2017-04-28 2020-02-07 宁波华科润生物科技有限公司 Centrum fusion device that passes through path access of wicresoft
EP4245269A1 (en) * 2022-03-16 2023-09-20 Cplasty B.V. Intervertebral disc implant

Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6425919B1 (en) * 1999-08-18 2002-07-30 Intrinsic Orthopedics, Inc. Devices and methods of vertebral disc augmentation
US20020165542A1 (en) * 1999-10-08 2002-11-07 Ferree Bret A. Annulus fibrosis augmentation methods and apparatus
US20030125807A1 (en) * 1999-08-18 2003-07-03 Gregory Lambrecht Encapsulated intervertebral disc prosthesis and methods of manufacture

Patent Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6425919B1 (en) * 1999-08-18 2002-07-30 Intrinsic Orthopedics, Inc. Devices and methods of vertebral disc augmentation
US20030125807A1 (en) * 1999-08-18 2003-07-03 Gregory Lambrecht Encapsulated intervertebral disc prosthesis and methods of manufacture
US20020165542A1 (en) * 1999-10-08 2002-11-07 Ferree Bret A. Annulus fibrosis augmentation methods and apparatus

Non-Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
See also references of WO2005041813A2 *

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
CA2543121A1 (en) 2005-05-12
WO2005041813A3 (en) 2005-08-11
WO2005041813A2 (en) 2005-05-12
JP2007527273A (en) 2007-09-27
EP1686929A2 (en) 2006-08-09

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US7553329B2 (en) Stabilized intervertebral disc barrier
US7998213B2 (en) Intervertebral disc herniation repair
US7563282B2 (en) Method of supporting nucleus pulposus
US20120316648A1 (en) Intervertebral disc reinforcement systems
US20030093155A1 (en) Deployment devices and methods for vertebral disc augmentation
IL148121A (en) Devices for vertebral disc augmentation
WO2005041813A2 (en) Stabilized intervertebral disc barrier
AU2002243434B2 (en) Devices and method for nucleus pulposus augmentation and retention
AU2002243434A1 (en) Devices and method for nucleus pulposus augmentation and retention

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
PUAI Public reference made under article 153(3) epc to a published international application that has entered the european phase

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: 0009012

17P Request for examination filed

Effective date: 20060509

AK Designated contracting states

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE ES FI FR GB GR HU IE IT LI LU MC NL PL PT RO SE SI SK TR

DAX Request for extension of the european patent (deleted)
A4 Supplementary search report drawn up and despatched

Effective date: 20090406

RIC1 Information provided on ipc code assigned before grant

Ipc: A61F 2/44 20060101ALI20090331BHEP

Ipc: A61F 2/08 20060101AFI20050901BHEP

Ipc: A61B 17/22 20060101ALI20090331BHEP

Ipc: A61B 5/107 20060101ALI20090331BHEP

Ipc: A61F 2/46 20060101ALI20090331BHEP

17Q First examination report despatched

Effective date: 20110126

STAA Information on the status of an ep patent application or granted ep patent

Free format text: STATUS: THE APPLICATION IS DEEMED TO BE WITHDRAWN

18D Application deemed to be withdrawn

Effective date: 20121128